1 //===--- ASTContext.cpp - Context to hold long-lived AST nodes ------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 //  This file implements the ASTContext interface.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
15 #include "CXXABI.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Attr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/Comment.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/CommentCommandTraits.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExternalASTSource.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Mangle.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/MangleNumberingContext.h"
29 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
30 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
31 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
32 #include "clang/AST/VTableBuilder.h"
33 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
34 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
35 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
38 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
39 #include "llvm/Support/Capacity.h"
40 #include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
41 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
42 #include <map>
43 
44 using namespace clang;
45 
46 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructors;
47 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared;
48 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructors;
49 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared;
50 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructors;
51 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared;
52 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators;
53 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
54 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators;
55 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared;
56 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructors;
57 unsigned ASTContext::NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared;
58 
59 enum FloatingRank {
60   HalfRank, FloatRank, DoubleRank, LongDoubleRank
61 };
62 
63 RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(const Decl *D) const {
64   if (!CommentsLoaded && ExternalSource) {
65     ExternalSource->ReadComments();
66 
67 #ifndef NDEBUG
68     ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
69     assert(std::is_sorted(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
70                           BeforeThanCompare<RawComment>(SourceMgr)));
71 #endif
72 
73     CommentsLoaded = true;
74   }
75 
76   assert(D);
77 
78   // User can not attach documentation to implicit declarations.
79   if (D->isImplicit())
80     return nullptr;
81 
82   // User can not attach documentation to implicit instantiations.
83   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
84     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
85       return nullptr;
86   }
87 
88   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
89     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
90         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
91       return nullptr;
92   }
93 
94   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
95     if (CRD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
96       return nullptr;
97   }
98 
99   if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
100           dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D)) {
101     TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = CTSD->getSpecializationKind();
102     if (TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation ||
103         TSK == TSK_Undeclared)
104       return nullptr;
105   }
106 
107   if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
108     if (ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
109       return nullptr;
110   }
111   if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
112     // When tag declaration (but not definition!) is part of the
113     // decl-specifier-seq of some other declaration, it doesn't get comment
114     if (TD->isEmbeddedInDeclarator() && !TD->isCompleteDefinition())
115       return nullptr;
116   }
117   // TODO: handle comments for function parameters properly.
118   if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D))
119     return nullptr;
120 
121   // TODO: we could look up template parameter documentation in the template
122   // documentation.
123   if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(D) ||
124       isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(D) ||
125       isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(D))
126     return nullptr;
127 
128   ArrayRef<RawComment *> RawComments = Comments.getComments();
129 
130   // If there are no comments anywhere, we won't find anything.
131   if (RawComments.empty())
132     return nullptr;
133 
134   // Find declaration location.
135   // For Objective-C declarations we generally don't expect to have multiple
136   // declarators, thus use declaration starting location as the "declaration
137   // location".
138   // For all other declarations multiple declarators are used quite frequently,
139   // so we use the location of the identifier as the "declaration location".
140   SourceLocation DeclLoc;
141   if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(D) ||
142       isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D) ||
143       isa<RedeclarableTemplateDecl>(D) ||
144       isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(D))
145     DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
146   else {
147     DeclLoc = D->getLocation();
148     if (DeclLoc.isMacroID()) {
149       if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
150         // If location of the typedef name is in a macro, it is because being
151         // declared via a macro. Try using declaration's starting location as
152         // the "declaration location".
153         DeclLoc = D->getLocStart();
154       } else if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D)) {
155         // If location of the tag decl is inside a macro, but the spelling of
156         // the tag name comes from a macro argument, it looks like a special
157         // macro like NS_ENUM is being used to define the tag decl.  In that
158         // case, adjust the source location to the expansion loc so that we can
159         // attach the comment to the tag decl.
160         if (SourceMgr.isMacroArgExpansion(DeclLoc) &&
161             TD->isCompleteDefinition())
162           DeclLoc = SourceMgr.getExpansionLoc(DeclLoc);
163       }
164     }
165   }
166 
167   // If the declaration doesn't map directly to a location in a file, we
168   // can't find the comment.
169   if (DeclLoc.isInvalid() || !DeclLoc.isFileID())
170     return nullptr;
171 
172   // Find the comment that occurs just after this declaration.
173   ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator Comment;
174   {
175     // When searching for comments during parsing, the comment we are looking
176     // for is usually among the last two comments we parsed -- check them
177     // first.
178     RawComment CommentAtDeclLoc(
179         SourceMgr, SourceRange(DeclLoc), false,
180         LangOpts.CommentOpts.ParseAllComments);
181     BeforeThanCompare<RawComment> Compare(SourceMgr);
182     ArrayRef<RawComment *>::iterator MaybeBeforeDecl = RawComments.end() - 1;
183     bool Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
184     if (!Found && RawComments.size() >= 2) {
185       MaybeBeforeDecl--;
186       Found = Compare(*MaybeBeforeDecl, &CommentAtDeclLoc);
187     }
188 
189     if (Found) {
190       Comment = MaybeBeforeDecl + 1;
191       assert(Comment == std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
192                                          &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare));
193     } else {
194       // Slow path.
195       Comment = std::lower_bound(RawComments.begin(), RawComments.end(),
196                                  &CommentAtDeclLoc, Compare);
197     }
198   }
199 
200   // Decompose the location for the declaration and find the beginning of the
201   // file buffer.
202   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> DeclLocDecomp = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc(DeclLoc);
203 
204   // First check whether we have a trailing comment.
205   if (Comment != RawComments.end() &&
206       (*Comment)->isDocumentation() && (*Comment)->isTrailingComment() &&
207       (isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<EnumConstantDecl>(D) || isa<VarDecl>(D) ||
208        isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<ObjCPropertyDecl>(D))) {
209     std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentBeginDecomp
210       = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getBegin());
211     // Check that Doxygen trailing comment comes after the declaration, starts
212     // on the same line and in the same file as the declaration.
213     if (DeclLocDecomp.first == CommentBeginDecomp.first &&
214         SourceMgr.getLineNumber(DeclLocDecomp.first, DeclLocDecomp.second)
215           == SourceMgr.getLineNumber(CommentBeginDecomp.first,
216                                      CommentBeginDecomp.second)) {
217       return *Comment;
218     }
219   }
220 
221   // The comment just after the declaration was not a trailing comment.
222   // Let's look at the previous comment.
223   if (Comment == RawComments.begin())
224     return nullptr;
225   --Comment;
226 
227   // Check that we actually have a non-member Doxygen comment.
228   if (!(*Comment)->isDocumentation() || (*Comment)->isTrailingComment())
229     return nullptr;
230 
231   // Decompose the end of the comment.
232   std::pair<FileID, unsigned> CommentEndDecomp
233     = SourceMgr.getDecomposedLoc((*Comment)->getSourceRange().getEnd());
234 
235   // If the comment and the declaration aren't in the same file, then they
236   // aren't related.
237   if (DeclLocDecomp.first != CommentEndDecomp.first)
238     return nullptr;
239 
240   // Get the corresponding buffer.
241   bool Invalid = false;
242   const char *Buffer = SourceMgr.getBufferData(DeclLocDecomp.first,
243                                                &Invalid).data();
244   if (Invalid)
245     return nullptr;
246 
247   // Extract text between the comment and declaration.
248   StringRef Text(Buffer + CommentEndDecomp.second,
249                  DeclLocDecomp.second - CommentEndDecomp.second);
250 
251   // There should be no other declarations or preprocessor directives between
252   // comment and declaration.
253   if (Text.find_first_of(";{}#@") != StringRef::npos)
254     return nullptr;
255 
256   return *Comment;
257 }
258 
259 namespace {
260 /// If we have a 'templated' declaration for a template, adjust 'D' to
261 /// refer to the actual template.
262 /// If we have an implicit instantiation, adjust 'D' to refer to template.
263 const Decl *adjustDeclToTemplate(const Decl *D) {
264   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
265     // Is this function declaration part of a function template?
266     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
267       return FTD;
268 
269     // Nothing to do if function is not an implicit instantiation.
270     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
271       return D;
272 
273     // Function is an implicit instantiation of a function template?
274     if (const FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = FD->getPrimaryTemplate())
275       return FTD;
276 
277     // Function is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
278     if (const FunctionDecl *MemberDecl =
279             FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction())
280       return MemberDecl;
281 
282     return D;
283   }
284   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
285     // Static data member is instantiated from a member definition of a class
286     // template?
287     if (VD->isStaticDataMember())
288       if (const VarDecl *MemberDecl = VD->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember())
289         return MemberDecl;
290 
291     return D;
292   }
293   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
294     // Is this class declaration part of a class template?
295     if (const ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = CRD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
296       return CTD;
297 
298     // Class is an implicit instantiation of a class template or partial
299     // specialization?
300     if (const ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *CTSD =
301             dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(CRD)) {
302       if (CTSD->getSpecializationKind() != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
303         return D;
304       llvm::PointerUnion<ClassTemplateDecl *,
305                          ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>
306           PU = CTSD->getSpecializedTemplateOrPartial();
307       return PU.is<ClassTemplateDecl*>() ?
308           static_cast<const Decl*>(PU.get<ClassTemplateDecl *>()) :
309           static_cast<const Decl*>(
310               PU.get<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *>());
311     }
312 
313     // Class is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
314     if (const MemberSpecializationInfo *Info =
315                    CRD->getMemberSpecializationInfo())
316       return Info->getInstantiatedFrom();
317 
318     return D;
319   }
320   if (const EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(D)) {
321     // Enum is instantiated from a member definition of a class template?
322     if (const EnumDecl *MemberDecl = ED->getInstantiatedFromMemberEnum())
323       return MemberDecl;
324 
325     return D;
326   }
327   // FIXME: Adjust alias templates?
328   return D;
329 }
330 } // unnamed namespace
331 
332 const RawComment *ASTContext::getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(
333                                                 const Decl *D,
334                                                 const Decl **OriginalDecl) const {
335   D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
336 
337   // Check whether we have cached a comment for this declaration already.
338   {
339     llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
340         RedeclComments.find(D);
341     if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
342       const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
343       if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
344         if (OriginalDecl)
345           *OriginalDecl = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
346         return Raw.getRaw();
347       }
348     }
349   }
350 
351   // Search for comments attached to declarations in the redeclaration chain.
352   const RawComment *RC = nullptr;
353   const Decl *OriginalDeclForRC = nullptr;
354   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
355     llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, RawCommentAndCacheFlags>::iterator Pos =
356         RedeclComments.find(I);
357     if (Pos != RedeclComments.end()) {
358       const RawCommentAndCacheFlags &Raw = Pos->second;
359       if (Raw.getKind() != RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl) {
360         RC = Raw.getRaw();
361         OriginalDeclForRC = Raw.getOriginalDecl();
362         break;
363       }
364     } else {
365       RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(I);
366       OriginalDeclForRC = I;
367       RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
368       if (RC) {
369         Raw.setRaw(RC);
370         Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromDecl);
371       } else
372         Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl);
373       Raw.setOriginalDecl(I);
374       RedeclComments[I] = Raw;
375       if (RC)
376         break;
377     }
378   }
379 
380   // If we found a comment, it should be a documentation comment.
381   assert(!RC || RC->isDocumentation());
382 
383   if (OriginalDecl)
384     *OriginalDecl = OriginalDeclForRC;
385 
386   // Update cache for every declaration in the redeclaration chain.
387   RawCommentAndCacheFlags Raw;
388   Raw.setRaw(RC);
389   Raw.setKind(RawCommentAndCacheFlags::FromRedecl);
390   Raw.setOriginalDecl(OriginalDeclForRC);
391 
392   for (auto I : D->redecls()) {
393     RawCommentAndCacheFlags &R = RedeclComments[I];
394     if (R.getKind() == RawCommentAndCacheFlags::NoCommentInDecl)
395       R = Raw;
396   }
397 
398   return RC;
399 }
400 
401 static void addRedeclaredMethods(const ObjCMethodDecl *ObjCMethod,
402                    SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Redeclared) {
403   const DeclContext *DC = ObjCMethod->getDeclContext();
404   if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD = dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(DC)) {
405     const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = IMD->getClassInterface();
406     if (!ID)
407       return;
408     // Add redeclared method here.
409     for (const auto *Ext : ID->known_extensions()) {
410       if (ObjCMethodDecl *RedeclaredMethod =
411             Ext->getMethod(ObjCMethod->getSelector(),
412                                   ObjCMethod->isInstanceMethod()))
413         Redeclared.push_back(RedeclaredMethod);
414     }
415   }
416 }
417 
418 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::cloneFullComment(comments::FullComment *FC,
419                                                     const Decl *D) const {
420   comments::DeclInfo *ThisDeclInfo = new (*this) comments::DeclInfo;
421   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = D;
422   ThisDeclInfo->IsFilled = false;
423   ThisDeclInfo->fill();
424   ThisDeclInfo->CommentDecl = FC->getDecl();
425   if (!ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters)
426     ThisDeclInfo->TemplateParameters = FC->getDeclInfo()->TemplateParameters;
427   comments::FullComment *CFC =
428     new (*this) comments::FullComment(FC->getBlocks(),
429                                       ThisDeclInfo);
430   return CFC;
431 
432 }
433 
434 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getLocalCommentForDeclUncached(const Decl *D) const {
435   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForDeclNoCache(D);
436   return RC ? RC->parse(*this, nullptr, D) : nullptr;
437 }
438 
439 comments::FullComment *ASTContext::getCommentForDecl(
440                                               const Decl *D,
441                                               const Preprocessor *PP) const {
442   if (D->isInvalidDecl())
443     return nullptr;
444   D = adjustDeclToTemplate(D);
445 
446   const Decl *Canonical = D->getCanonicalDecl();
447   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl *, comments::FullComment *>::iterator Pos =
448       ParsedComments.find(Canonical);
449 
450   if (Pos != ParsedComments.end()) {
451     if (Canonical != D) {
452       comments::FullComment *FC = Pos->second;
453       comments::FullComment *CFC = cloneFullComment(FC, D);
454       return CFC;
455     }
456     return Pos->second;
457   }
458 
459   const Decl *OriginalDecl;
460 
461   const RawComment *RC = getRawCommentForAnyRedecl(D, &OriginalDecl);
462   if (!RC) {
463     if (isa<ObjCMethodDecl>(D) || isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
464       SmallVector<const NamedDecl*, 8> Overridden;
465       const ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
466       if (OMD && OMD->isPropertyAccessor())
467         if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = OMD->findPropertyDecl())
468           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(PDecl, PP))
469             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
470       if (OMD)
471         addRedeclaredMethods(OMD, Overridden);
472       getOverriddenMethods(dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(D), Overridden);
473       for (unsigned i = 0, e = Overridden.size(); i < e; i++)
474         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(Overridden[i], PP))
475           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
476     }
477     else if (const TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
478       // Attach any tag type's documentation to its typedef if latter
479       // does not have one of its own.
480       QualType QT = TD->getUnderlyingType();
481       if (const TagType *TT = QT->getAs<TagType>())
482         if (const Decl *TD = TT->getDecl())
483           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(TD, PP))
484             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
485     }
486     else if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
487       while (IC->getSuperClass()) {
488         IC = IC->getSuperClass();
489         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
490           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
491       }
492     }
493     else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(D)) {
494       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC = CD->getClassInterface())
495         if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl(IC, PP))
496           return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
497     }
498     else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) {
499       if (!(RD = RD->getDefinition()))
500         return nullptr;
501       // Check non-virtual bases.
502       for (const auto &I : RD->bases()) {
503         if (I.isVirtual() || (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public))
504           continue;
505         QualType Ty = I.getType();
506         if (Ty.isNull())
507           continue;
508         if (const CXXRecordDecl *NonVirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
509           if (!(NonVirtualBase= NonVirtualBase->getDefinition()))
510             continue;
511 
512           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((NonVirtualBase), PP))
513             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
514         }
515       }
516       // Check virtual bases.
517       for (const auto &I : RD->vbases()) {
518         if (I.getAccessSpecifier() != AS_public)
519           continue;
520         QualType Ty = I.getType();
521         if (Ty.isNull())
522           continue;
523         if (const CXXRecordDecl *VirtualBase = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
524           if (!(VirtualBase= VirtualBase->getDefinition()))
525             continue;
526           if (comments::FullComment *FC = getCommentForDecl((VirtualBase), PP))
527             return cloneFullComment(FC, D);
528         }
529       }
530     }
531     return nullptr;
532   }
533 
534   // If the RawComment was attached to other redeclaration of this Decl, we
535   // should parse the comment in context of that other Decl.  This is important
536   // because comments can contain references to parameter names which can be
537   // different across redeclarations.
538   if (D != OriginalDecl)
539     return getCommentForDecl(OriginalDecl, PP);
540 
541   comments::FullComment *FC = RC->parse(*this, PP, D);
542   ParsedComments[Canonical] = FC;
543   return FC;
544 }
545 
546 void
547 ASTContext::CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(llvm::FoldingSetNodeID &ID,
548                                                TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Parm) {
549   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getDepth());
550   ID.AddInteger(Parm->getPosition());
551   ID.AddBoolean(Parm->isParameterPack());
552 
553   TemplateParameterList *Params = Parm->getTemplateParameters();
554   ID.AddInteger(Params->size());
555   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
556                                           PEnd = Params->end();
557        P != PEnd; ++P) {
558     if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P)) {
559       ID.AddInteger(0);
560       ID.AddBoolean(TTP->isParameterPack());
561       continue;
562     }
563 
564     if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
565       ID.AddInteger(1);
566       ID.AddBoolean(NTTP->isParameterPack());
567       ID.AddPointer(NTTP->getType().getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
568       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
569         ID.AddBoolean(true);
570         ID.AddInteger(NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes());
571         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
572           QualType T = NTTP->getExpansionType(I);
573           ID.AddPointer(T.getCanonicalType().getAsOpaquePtr());
574         }
575       } else
576         ID.AddBoolean(false);
577       continue;
578     }
579 
580     TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P);
581     ID.AddInteger(2);
582     Profile(ID, TTP);
583   }
584 }
585 
586 TemplateTemplateParmDecl *
587 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
588                                           TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP) const {
589   // Check if we already have a canonical template template parameter.
590   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
591   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm::Profile(ID, TTP);
592   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
593   CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm *Canonical
594     = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
595   if (Canonical)
596     return Canonical->getParam();
597 
598   // Build a canonical template parameter list.
599   TemplateParameterList *Params = TTP->getTemplateParameters();
600   SmallVector<NamedDecl *, 4> CanonParams;
601   CanonParams.reserve(Params->size());
602   for (TemplateParameterList::const_iterator P = Params->begin(),
603                                           PEnd = Params->end();
604        P != PEnd; ++P) {
605     if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(*P))
606       CanonParams.push_back(
607                   TemplateTypeParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
608                                                SourceLocation(),
609                                                SourceLocation(),
610                                                TTP->getDepth(),
611                                                TTP->getIndex(), nullptr, false,
612                                                TTP->isParameterPack()));
613     else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
614              = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(*P)) {
615       QualType T = getCanonicalType(NTTP->getType());
616       TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
617       NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *Param;
618       if (NTTP->isExpandedParameterPack()) {
619         SmallVector<QualType, 2> ExpandedTypes;
620         SmallVector<TypeSourceInfo *, 2> ExpandedTInfos;
621         for (unsigned I = 0, N = NTTP->getNumExpansionTypes(); I != N; ++I) {
622           ExpandedTypes.push_back(getCanonicalType(NTTP->getExpansionType(I)));
623           ExpandedTInfos.push_back(
624                                 getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ExpandedTypes.back()));
625         }
626 
627         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
628                                                 SourceLocation(),
629                                                 SourceLocation(),
630                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
631                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
632                                                 T,
633                                                 TInfo,
634                                                 ExpandedTypes.data(),
635                                                 ExpandedTypes.size(),
636                                                 ExpandedTInfos.data());
637       } else {
638         Param = NonTypeTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
639                                                 SourceLocation(),
640                                                 SourceLocation(),
641                                                 NTTP->getDepth(),
642                                                 NTTP->getPosition(), nullptr,
643                                                 T,
644                                                 NTTP->isParameterPack(),
645                                                 TInfo);
646       }
647       CanonParams.push_back(Param);
648 
649     } else
650       CanonParams.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(
651                                            cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(*P)));
652   }
653 
654   TemplateTemplateParmDecl *CanonTTP
655     = TemplateTemplateParmDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
656                                        SourceLocation(), TTP->getDepth(),
657                                        TTP->getPosition(),
658                                        TTP->isParameterPack(),
659                                        nullptr,
660                          TemplateParameterList::Create(*this, SourceLocation(),
661                                                        SourceLocation(),
662                                                        CanonParams.data(),
663                                                        CanonParams.size(),
664                                                        SourceLocation()));
665 
666   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
667   Canonical = CanonTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
668   assert(!Canonical && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
669   (void)Canonical;
670 
671   // Create the canonical template template parameter entry.
672   Canonical = new (*this) CanonicalTemplateTemplateParm(CanonTTP);
673   CanonTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(Canonical, InsertPos);
674   return CanonTTP;
675 }
676 
677 CXXABI *ASTContext::createCXXABI(const TargetInfo &T) {
678   if (!LangOpts.CPlusPlus) return nullptr;
679 
680   switch (T.getCXXABI().getKind()) {
681   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM: // Same as Itanium at this level
682   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
683   case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
684   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
685   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
686   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
687     return CreateItaniumCXXABI(*this);
688   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
689     return CreateMicrosoftCXXABI(*this);
690   }
691   llvm_unreachable("Invalid CXXABI type!");
692 }
693 
694 static const LangAS::Map *getAddressSpaceMap(const TargetInfo &T,
695                                              const LangOptions &LOpts) {
696   if (LOpts.FakeAddressSpaceMap) {
697     // The fake address space map must have a distinct entry for each
698     // language-specific address space.
699     static const unsigned FakeAddrSpaceMap[] = {
700       1, // opencl_global
701       2, // opencl_local
702       3, // opencl_constant
703       4, // opencl_generic
704       5, // cuda_device
705       6, // cuda_constant
706       7  // cuda_shared
707     };
708     return &FakeAddrSpaceMap;
709   } else {
710     return &T.getAddressSpaceMap();
711   }
712 }
713 
714 static bool isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(const TargetInfo &TI,
715                                           const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
716   switch (LangOpts.getAddressSpaceMapMangling()) {
717   case LangOptions::ASMM_Target:
718     return TI.useAddressSpaceMapMangling();
719   case LangOptions::ASMM_On:
720     return true;
721   case LangOptions::ASMM_Off:
722     return false;
723   }
724   llvm_unreachable("getAddressSpaceMapMangling() doesn't cover anything.");
725 }
726 
727 ASTContext::ASTContext(LangOptions &LOpts, SourceManager &SM,
728                        IdentifierTable &idents, SelectorTable &sels,
729                        Builtin::Context &builtins)
730     : FunctionProtoTypes(this_()), TemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
731       DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes(this_()),
732       SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks(this_()),
733       GlobalNestedNameSpecifier(nullptr), Int128Decl(nullptr),
734       UInt128Decl(nullptr), Float128StubDecl(nullptr),
735       BuiltinVaListDecl(nullptr), ObjCIdDecl(nullptr), ObjCSelDecl(nullptr),
736       ObjCClassDecl(nullptr), ObjCProtocolClassDecl(nullptr), BOOLDecl(nullptr),
737       CFConstantStringTypeDecl(nullptr), ObjCInstanceTypeDecl(nullptr),
738       FILEDecl(nullptr), jmp_bufDecl(nullptr), sigjmp_bufDecl(nullptr),
739       ucontext_tDecl(nullptr), BlockDescriptorType(nullptr),
740       BlockDescriptorExtendedType(nullptr), cudaConfigureCallDecl(nullptr),
741       FirstLocalImport(), LastLocalImport(), ExternCContext(nullptr),
742       SourceMgr(SM), LangOpts(LOpts),
743       SanitizerBL(new SanitizerBlacklist(LangOpts.SanitizerBlacklistFiles, SM)),
744       AddrSpaceMap(nullptr), Target(nullptr), PrintingPolicy(LOpts),
745       Idents(idents), Selectors(sels), BuiltinInfo(builtins),
746       DeclarationNames(*this), ExternalSource(nullptr), Listener(nullptr),
747       Comments(SM), CommentsLoaded(false),
748       CommentCommandTraits(BumpAlloc, LOpts.CommentOpts), LastSDM(nullptr, 0) {
749   TUDecl = TranslationUnitDecl::Create(*this);
750 }
751 
752 ASTContext::~ASTContext() {
753   ReleaseParentMapEntries();
754 
755   // Release the DenseMaps associated with DeclContext objects.
756   // FIXME: Is this the ideal solution?
757   ReleaseDeclContextMaps();
758 
759   // Call all of the deallocation functions on all of their targets.
760   for (DeallocationMap::const_iterator I = Deallocations.begin(),
761            E = Deallocations.end(); I != E; ++I)
762     for (unsigned J = 0, N = I->second.size(); J != N; ++J)
763       (I->first)((I->second)[J]);
764 
765   // ASTRecordLayout objects in ASTRecordLayouts must always be destroyed
766   // because they can contain DenseMaps.
767   for (llvm::DenseMap<const ObjCContainerDecl*,
768        const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
769        I = ObjCLayouts.begin(), E = ObjCLayouts.end(); I != E; )
770     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
771     if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
772       R->Destroy(*this);
773 
774   for (llvm::DenseMap<const RecordDecl*, const ASTRecordLayout*>::iterator
775        I = ASTRecordLayouts.begin(), E = ASTRecordLayouts.end(); I != E; ) {
776     // Increment in loop to prevent using deallocated memory.
777     if (ASTRecordLayout *R = const_cast<ASTRecordLayout*>((I++)->second))
778       R->Destroy(*this);
779   }
780 
781   for (llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator A = DeclAttrs.begin(),
782                                                     AEnd = DeclAttrs.end();
783        A != AEnd; ++A)
784     A->second->~AttrVec();
785 
786   llvm::DeleteContainerSeconds(MangleNumberingContexts);
787 }
788 
789 void ASTContext::ReleaseParentMapEntries() {
790   if (!AllParents) return;
791   for (const auto &Entry : *AllParents) {
792     if (Entry.second.is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
793       delete Entry.second.get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
794     } else {
795       assert(Entry.second.is<ParentVector *>());
796       delete Entry.second.get<ParentVector *>();
797     }
798   }
799 }
800 
801 void ASTContext::AddDeallocation(void (*Callback)(void*), void *Data) {
802   Deallocations[Callback].push_back(Data);
803 }
804 
805 void
806 ASTContext::setExternalSource(IntrusiveRefCntPtr<ExternalASTSource> Source) {
807   ExternalSource = Source;
808 }
809 
810 void ASTContext::PrintStats() const {
811   llvm::errs() << "\n*** AST Context Stats:\n";
812   llvm::errs() << "  " << Types.size() << " types total.\n";
813 
814   unsigned counts[] = {
815 #define TYPE(Name, Parent) 0,
816 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
817 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
818     0 // Extra
819   };
820 
821   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Types.size(); i != e; ++i) {
822     Type *T = Types[i];
823     counts[(unsigned)T->getTypeClass()]++;
824   }
825 
826   unsigned Idx = 0;
827   unsigned TotalBytes = 0;
828 #define TYPE(Name, Parent)                                              \
829   if (counts[Idx])                                                      \
830     llvm::errs() << "    " << counts[Idx] << " " << #Name               \
831                  << " types\n";                                         \
832   TotalBytes += counts[Idx] * sizeof(Name##Type);                       \
833   ++Idx;
834 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Name, Parent)
835 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
836 
837   llvm::errs() << "Total bytes = " << TotalBytes << "\n";
838 
839   // Implicit special member functions.
840   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDefaultConstructorsDeclared << "/"
841                << NumImplicitDefaultConstructors
842                << " implicit default constructors created\n";
843   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyConstructorsDeclared << "/"
844                << NumImplicitCopyConstructors
845                << " implicit copy constructors created\n";
846   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
847     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveConstructorsDeclared << "/"
848                  << NumImplicitMoveConstructors
849                  << " implicit move constructors created\n";
850   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
851                << NumImplicitCopyAssignmentOperators
852                << " implicit copy assignment operators created\n";
853   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
854     llvm::errs() << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperatorsDeclared << "/"
855                  << NumImplicitMoveAssignmentOperators
856                  << " implicit move assignment operators created\n";
857   llvm::errs() << NumImplicitDestructorsDeclared << "/"
858                << NumImplicitDestructors
859                << " implicit destructors created\n";
860 
861   if (ExternalSource) {
862     llvm::errs() << "\n";
863     ExternalSource->PrintStats();
864   }
865 
866   BumpAlloc.PrintStats();
867 }
868 
869 ExternCContextDecl *ASTContext::getExternCContextDecl() const {
870   if (!ExternCContext)
871     ExternCContext = ExternCContextDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl());
872 
873   return ExternCContext;
874 }
875 
876 RecordDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitRecord(StringRef Name,
877                                             RecordDecl::TagKind TK) const {
878   SourceLocation Loc;
879   RecordDecl *NewDecl;
880   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
881     NewDecl = CXXRecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc,
882                                     Loc, &Idents.get(Name));
883   else
884     NewDecl = RecordDecl::Create(*this, TK, getTranslationUnitDecl(), Loc, Loc,
885                                  &Idents.get(Name));
886   NewDecl->setImplicit();
887   NewDecl->addAttr(TypeVisibilityAttr::CreateImplicit(
888       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), TypeVisibilityAttr::Default));
889   return NewDecl;
890 }
891 
892 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::buildImplicitTypedef(QualType T,
893                                               StringRef Name) const {
894   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
895   TypedefDecl *NewDecl = TypedefDecl::Create(
896       const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), getTranslationUnitDecl(),
897       SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), &Idents.get(Name), TInfo);
898   NewDecl->setImplicit();
899   return NewDecl;
900 }
901 
902 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getInt128Decl() const {
903   if (!Int128Decl)
904     Int128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(Int128Ty, "__int128_t");
905   return Int128Decl;
906 }
907 
908 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getUInt128Decl() const {
909   if (!UInt128Decl)
910     UInt128Decl = buildImplicitTypedef(UnsignedInt128Ty, "__uint128_t");
911   return UInt128Decl;
912 }
913 
914 TypeDecl *ASTContext::getFloat128StubType() const {
915   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus && "should only be called for c++");
916   if (!Float128StubDecl)
917     Float128StubDecl = buildImplicitRecord("__float128");
918 
919   return Float128StubDecl;
920 }
921 
922 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinType(CanQualType &R, BuiltinType::Kind K) {
923   BuiltinType *Ty = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BuiltinType(K);
924   R = CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(QualType(Ty, 0));
925   Types.push_back(Ty);
926 }
927 
928 void ASTContext::InitBuiltinTypes(const TargetInfo &Target) {
929   assert((!this->Target || this->Target == &Target) &&
930          "Incorrect target reinitialization");
931   assert(VoidTy.isNull() && "Context reinitialized?");
932 
933   this->Target = &Target;
934 
935   ABI.reset(createCXXABI(Target));
936   AddrSpaceMap = getAddressSpaceMap(Target, LangOpts);
937   AddrSpaceMapMangling = isAddrSpaceMapManglingEnabled(Target, LangOpts);
938 
939   // C99 6.2.5p19.
940   InitBuiltinType(VoidTy,              BuiltinType::Void);
941 
942   // C99 6.2.5p2.
943   InitBuiltinType(BoolTy,              BuiltinType::Bool);
944   // C99 6.2.5p3.
945   if (LangOpts.CharIsSigned)
946     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_S);
947   else
948     InitBuiltinType(CharTy,            BuiltinType::Char_U);
949   // C99 6.2.5p4.
950   InitBuiltinType(SignedCharTy,        BuiltinType::SChar);
951   InitBuiltinType(ShortTy,             BuiltinType::Short);
952   InitBuiltinType(IntTy,               BuiltinType::Int);
953   InitBuiltinType(LongTy,              BuiltinType::Long);
954   InitBuiltinType(LongLongTy,          BuiltinType::LongLong);
955 
956   // C99 6.2.5p6.
957   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedCharTy,      BuiltinType::UChar);
958   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedShortTy,     BuiltinType::UShort);
959   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedIntTy,       BuiltinType::UInt);
960   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongTy,      BuiltinType::ULong);
961   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedLongLongTy,  BuiltinType::ULongLong);
962 
963   // C99 6.2.5p10.
964   InitBuiltinType(FloatTy,             BuiltinType::Float);
965   InitBuiltinType(DoubleTy,            BuiltinType::Double);
966   InitBuiltinType(LongDoubleTy,        BuiltinType::LongDouble);
967 
968   // GNU extension, 128-bit integers.
969   InitBuiltinType(Int128Ty,            BuiltinType::Int128);
970   InitBuiltinType(UnsignedInt128Ty,    BuiltinType::UInt128);
971 
972   // C++ 3.9.1p5
973   if (TargetInfo::isTypeSigned(Target.getWCharType()))
974     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_S);
975   else  // -fshort-wchar makes wchar_t be unsigned.
976     InitBuiltinType(WCharTy,           BuiltinType::WChar_U);
977   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus && LangOpts.WChar)
978     WideCharTy = WCharTy;
979   else {
980     // C99 (or C++ using -fno-wchar).
981     WideCharTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWCharType());
982   }
983 
984   WIntTy = getFromTargetType(Target.getWIntType());
985 
986   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
987     InitBuiltinType(Char16Ty,           BuiltinType::Char16);
988   else // C99
989     Char16Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar16Type());
990 
991   if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) // C++0x 3.9.1p5, extension for C++
992     InitBuiltinType(Char32Ty,           BuiltinType::Char32);
993   else // C99
994     Char32Ty = getFromTargetType(Target.getChar32Type());
995 
996   // Placeholder type for type-dependent expressions whose type is
997   // completely unknown. No code should ever check a type against
998   // DependentTy and users should never see it; however, it is here to
999   // help diagnose failures to properly check for type-dependent
1000   // expressions.
1001   InitBuiltinType(DependentTy,         BuiltinType::Dependent);
1002 
1003   // Placeholder type for functions.
1004   InitBuiltinType(OverloadTy,          BuiltinType::Overload);
1005 
1006   // Placeholder type for bound members.
1007   InitBuiltinType(BoundMemberTy,       BuiltinType::BoundMember);
1008 
1009   // Placeholder type for pseudo-objects.
1010   InitBuiltinType(PseudoObjectTy,      BuiltinType::PseudoObject);
1011 
1012   // "any" type; useful for debugger-like clients.
1013   InitBuiltinType(UnknownAnyTy,        BuiltinType::UnknownAny);
1014 
1015   // Placeholder type for unbridged ARC casts.
1016   InitBuiltinType(ARCUnbridgedCastTy,  BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast);
1017 
1018   // Placeholder type for builtin functions.
1019   InitBuiltinType(BuiltinFnTy,  BuiltinType::BuiltinFn);
1020 
1021   // C99 6.2.5p11.
1022   FloatComplexTy      = getComplexType(FloatTy);
1023   DoubleComplexTy     = getComplexType(DoubleTy);
1024   LongDoubleComplexTy = getComplexType(LongDoubleTy);
1025 
1026   // Builtin types for 'id', 'Class', and 'SEL'.
1027   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, BuiltinType::ObjCId);
1028   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, BuiltinType::ObjCClass);
1029   InitBuiltinType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy, BuiltinType::ObjCSel);
1030 
1031   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
1032     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1d);
1033     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray);
1034     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage1dBufferTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer);
1035     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2d);
1036     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage2dArrayTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray);
1037     InitBuiltinType(OCLImage3dTy, BuiltinType::OCLImage3d);
1038 
1039     InitBuiltinType(OCLSamplerTy, BuiltinType::OCLSampler);
1040     InitBuiltinType(OCLEventTy, BuiltinType::OCLEvent);
1041   }
1042 
1043   // Builtin type for __objc_yes and __objc_no
1044   ObjCBuiltinBoolTy = (Target.useSignedCharForObjCBool() ?
1045                        SignedCharTy : BoolTy);
1046 
1047   ObjCConstantStringType = QualType();
1048 
1049   ObjCSuperType = QualType();
1050 
1051   // void * type
1052   VoidPtrTy = getPointerType(VoidTy);
1053 
1054   // nullptr type (C++0x 2.14.7)
1055   InitBuiltinType(NullPtrTy,           BuiltinType::NullPtr);
1056 
1057   // half type (OpenCL 6.1.1.1) / ARM NEON __fp16
1058   InitBuiltinType(HalfTy, BuiltinType::Half);
1059 
1060   // Builtin type used to help define __builtin_va_list.
1061   VaListTagTy = QualType();
1062 }
1063 
1064 DiagnosticsEngine &ASTContext::getDiagnostics() const {
1065   return SourceMgr.getDiagnostics();
1066 }
1067 
1068 AttrVec& ASTContext::getDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1069   AttrVec *&Result = DeclAttrs[D];
1070   if (!Result) {
1071     void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(AttrVec));
1072     Result = new (Mem) AttrVec;
1073   }
1074 
1075   return *Result;
1076 }
1077 
1078 /// \brief Erase the attributes corresponding to the given declaration.
1079 void ASTContext::eraseDeclAttrs(const Decl *D) {
1080   llvm::DenseMap<const Decl*, AttrVec*>::iterator Pos = DeclAttrs.find(D);
1081   if (Pos != DeclAttrs.end()) {
1082     Pos->second->~AttrVec();
1083     DeclAttrs.erase(Pos);
1084   }
1085 }
1086 
1087 // FIXME: Remove ?
1088 MemberSpecializationInfo *
1089 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(const VarDecl *Var) {
1090   assert(Var->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1091   return getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Var)
1092       .dyn_cast<MemberSpecializationInfo *>();
1093 }
1094 
1095 ASTContext::TemplateOrSpecializationInfo
1096 ASTContext::getTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(const VarDecl *Var) {
1097   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, TemplateOrSpecializationInfo>::iterator Pos =
1098       TemplateOrInstantiation.find(Var);
1099   if (Pos == TemplateOrInstantiation.end())
1100     return TemplateOrSpecializationInfo();
1101 
1102   return Pos->second;
1103 }
1104 
1105 void
1106 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember(VarDecl *Inst, VarDecl *Tmpl,
1107                                                 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK,
1108                                           SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation) {
1109   assert(Inst->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1110   assert(Tmpl->isStaticDataMember() && "Not a static data member");
1111   setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(Inst, new (*this) MemberSpecializationInfo(
1112                                             Tmpl, TSK, PointOfInstantiation));
1113 }
1114 
1115 void
1116 ASTContext::setTemplateOrSpecializationInfo(VarDecl *Inst,
1117                                             TemplateOrSpecializationInfo TSI) {
1118   assert(!TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] &&
1119          "Already noted what the variable was instantiated from");
1120   TemplateOrInstantiation[Inst] = TSI;
1121 }
1122 
1123 FunctionDecl *ASTContext::getClassScopeSpecializationPattern(
1124                                                      const FunctionDecl *FD){
1125   assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1126   llvm::DenseMap<const FunctionDecl*, FunctionDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1127     = ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.find(FD);
1128   if (Pos == ClassScopeSpecializationPattern.end())
1129     return nullptr;
1130 
1131   return Pos->second;
1132 }
1133 
1134 void ASTContext::setClassScopeSpecializationPattern(FunctionDecl *FD,
1135                                         FunctionDecl *Pattern) {
1136   assert(FD && "Specialization is 0");
1137   assert(Pattern && "Class scope specialization pattern is 0");
1138   ClassScopeSpecializationPattern[FD] = Pattern;
1139 }
1140 
1141 NamedDecl *
1142 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *UUD) {
1143   llvm::DenseMap<UsingDecl *, NamedDecl *>::const_iterator Pos
1144     = InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.find(UUD);
1145   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingDecl.end())
1146     return nullptr;
1147 
1148   return Pos->second;
1149 }
1150 
1151 void
1152 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingDecl(UsingDecl *Inst, NamedDecl *Pattern) {
1153   assert((isa<UsingDecl>(Pattern) ||
1154           isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(Pattern) ||
1155           isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Pattern)) &&
1156          "pattern decl is not a using decl");
1157   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1158   InstantiatedFromUsingDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1159 }
1160 
1161 UsingShadowDecl *
1162 ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst) {
1163   llvm::DenseMap<UsingShadowDecl*, UsingShadowDecl*>::const_iterator Pos
1164     = InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.find(Inst);
1165   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl.end())
1166     return nullptr;
1167 
1168   return Pos->second;
1169 }
1170 
1171 void
1172 ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl(UsingShadowDecl *Inst,
1173                                                UsingShadowDecl *Pattern) {
1174   assert(!InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] && "pattern already exists");
1175   InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl[Inst] = Pattern;
1176 }
1177 
1178 FieldDecl *ASTContext::getInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Field) {
1179   llvm::DenseMap<FieldDecl *, FieldDecl *>::iterator Pos
1180     = InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.find(Field);
1181   if (Pos == InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl.end())
1182     return nullptr;
1183 
1184   return Pos->second;
1185 }
1186 
1187 void ASTContext::setInstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl(FieldDecl *Inst,
1188                                                      FieldDecl *Tmpl) {
1189   assert(!Inst->getDeclName() && "Instantiated field decl is not unnamed");
1190   assert(!Tmpl->getDeclName() && "Template field decl is not unnamed");
1191   assert(!InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] &&
1192          "Already noted what unnamed field was instantiated from");
1193 
1194   InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl[Inst] = Tmpl;
1195 }
1196 
1197 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1198 ASTContext::overridden_methods_begin(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1199   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1200     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1201   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1202     return nullptr;
1203 
1204   return Pos->second.begin();
1205 }
1206 
1207 ASTContext::overridden_cxx_method_iterator
1208 ASTContext::overridden_methods_end(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1209   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1210     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1211   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1212     return nullptr;
1213 
1214   return Pos->second.end();
1215 }
1216 
1217 unsigned
1218 ASTContext::overridden_methods_size(const CXXMethodDecl *Method) const {
1219   llvm::DenseMap<const CXXMethodDecl *, CXXMethodVector>::const_iterator Pos
1220     = OverriddenMethods.find(Method->getCanonicalDecl());
1221   if (Pos == OverriddenMethods.end())
1222     return 0;
1223 
1224   return Pos->second.size();
1225 }
1226 
1227 void ASTContext::addOverriddenMethod(const CXXMethodDecl *Method,
1228                                      const CXXMethodDecl *Overridden) {
1229   assert(Method->isCanonicalDecl() && Overridden->isCanonicalDecl());
1230   OverriddenMethods[Method].push_back(Overridden);
1231 }
1232 
1233 void ASTContext::getOverriddenMethods(
1234                       const NamedDecl *D,
1235                       SmallVectorImpl<const NamedDecl *> &Overridden) const {
1236   assert(D);
1237 
1238   if (const CXXMethodDecl *CXXMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
1239     Overridden.append(overridden_methods_begin(CXXMethod),
1240                       overridden_methods_end(CXXMethod));
1241     return;
1242   }
1243 
1244   const ObjCMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D);
1245   if (!Method)
1246     return;
1247 
1248   SmallVector<const ObjCMethodDecl *, 8> OverDecls;
1249   Method->getOverriddenMethods(OverDecls);
1250   Overridden.append(OverDecls.begin(), OverDecls.end());
1251 }
1252 
1253 void ASTContext::addedLocalImportDecl(ImportDecl *Import) {
1254   assert(!Import->NextLocalImport && "Import declaration already in the chain");
1255   assert(!Import->isFromASTFile() && "Non-local import declaration");
1256   if (!FirstLocalImport) {
1257     FirstLocalImport = Import;
1258     LastLocalImport = Import;
1259     return;
1260   }
1261 
1262   LastLocalImport->NextLocalImport = Import;
1263   LastLocalImport = Import;
1264 }
1265 
1266 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1267 //                         Type Sizing and Analysis
1268 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1269 
1270 /// getFloatTypeSemantics - Return the APFloat 'semantics' for the specified
1271 /// scalar floating point type.
1272 const llvm::fltSemantics &ASTContext::getFloatTypeSemantics(QualType T) const {
1273   const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1274   assert(BT && "Not a floating point type!");
1275   switch (BT->getKind()) {
1276   default: llvm_unreachable("Not a floating point type!");
1277   case BuiltinType::Half:       return Target->getHalfFormat();
1278   case BuiltinType::Float:      return Target->getFloatFormat();
1279   case BuiltinType::Double:     return Target->getDoubleFormat();
1280   case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return Target->getLongDoubleFormat();
1281   }
1282 }
1283 
1284 CharUnits ASTContext::getDeclAlign(const Decl *D, bool ForAlignof) const {
1285   unsigned Align = Target->getCharWidth();
1286 
1287   bool UseAlignAttrOnly = false;
1288   if (unsigned AlignFromAttr = D->getMaxAlignment()) {
1289     Align = AlignFromAttr;
1290 
1291     // __attribute__((aligned)) can increase or decrease alignment
1292     // *except* on a struct or struct member, where it only increases
1293     // alignment unless 'packed' is also specified.
1294     //
1295     // It is an error for alignas to decrease alignment, so we can
1296     // ignore that possibility;  Sema should diagnose it.
1297     if (isa<FieldDecl>(D)) {
1298       UseAlignAttrOnly = D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1299         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1300     } else {
1301       UseAlignAttrOnly = true;
1302     }
1303   }
1304   else if (isa<FieldDecl>(D))
1305       UseAlignAttrOnly =
1306         D->hasAttr<PackedAttr>() ||
1307         cast<FieldDecl>(D)->getParent()->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
1308 
1309   // If we're using the align attribute only, just ignore everything
1310   // else about the declaration and its type.
1311   if (UseAlignAttrOnly) {
1312     // do nothing
1313 
1314   } else if (const ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D)) {
1315     QualType T = VD->getType();
1316     if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
1317       if (ForAlignof)
1318         T = RT->getPointeeType();
1319       else
1320         T = getPointerType(RT->getPointeeType());
1321     }
1322     QualType BaseT = getBaseElementType(T);
1323     if (!BaseT->isIncompleteType() && !T->isFunctionType()) {
1324       // Adjust alignments of declarations with array type by the
1325       // large-array alignment on the target.
1326       if (const ArrayType *arrayType = getAsArrayType(T)) {
1327         unsigned MinWidth = Target->getLargeArrayMinWidth();
1328         if (!ForAlignof && MinWidth) {
1329           if (isa<VariableArrayType>(arrayType))
1330             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1331           else if (isa<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType) &&
1332                    MinWidth <= getTypeSize(cast<ConstantArrayType>(arrayType)))
1333             Align = std::max(Align, Target->getLargeArrayAlign());
1334         }
1335       }
1336       Align = std::max(Align, getPreferredTypeAlign(T.getTypePtr()));
1337       if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1338         if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && !ForAlignof)
1339           Align = std::max(Align, getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1340       }
1341     }
1342 
1343     // Fields can be subject to extra alignment constraints, like if
1344     // the field is packed, the struct is packed, or the struct has a
1345     // a max-field-alignment constraint (#pragma pack).  So calculate
1346     // the actual alignment of the field within the struct, and then
1347     // (as we're expected to) constrain that by the alignment of the type.
1348     if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) {
1349       const RecordDecl *Parent = Field->getParent();
1350       // We can only produce a sensible answer if the record is valid.
1351       if (!Parent->isInvalidDecl()) {
1352         const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(Parent);
1353 
1354         // Start with the record's overall alignment.
1355         unsigned FieldAlign = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1356 
1357         // Use the GCD of that and the offset within the record.
1358         uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(Field->getFieldIndex());
1359         if (Offset > 0) {
1360           // Alignment is always a power of 2, so the GCD will be a power of 2,
1361           // which means we get to do this crazy thing instead of Euclid's.
1362           uint64_t LowBitOfOffset = Offset & (~Offset + 1);
1363           if (LowBitOfOffset < FieldAlign)
1364             FieldAlign = static_cast<unsigned>(LowBitOfOffset);
1365         }
1366 
1367         Align = std::min(Align, FieldAlign);
1368       }
1369     }
1370   }
1371 
1372   return toCharUnitsFromBits(Align);
1373 }
1374 
1375 // getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars - Return the size of a type, in
1376 // chars. If the type is a record, its data size is returned.  This is
1377 // the size of the memcpy that's performed when assigning this type
1378 // using a trivial copy/move assignment operator.
1379 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1380 ASTContext::getTypeInfoDataSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1381   std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> sizeAndAlign = getTypeInfoInChars(T);
1382 
1383   // In C++, objects can sometimes be allocated into the tail padding
1384   // of a base-class subobject.  We decide whether that's possible
1385   // during class layout, so here we can just trust the layout results.
1386   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1387     if (const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1388       const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RT->getDecl());
1389       sizeAndAlign.first = layout.getDataSize();
1390     }
1391   }
1392 
1393   return sizeAndAlign;
1394 }
1395 
1396 /// getConstantArrayInfoInChars - Performing the computation in CharUnits
1397 /// instead of in bits prevents overflowing the uint64_t for some large arrays.
1398 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1399 static getConstantArrayInfoInChars(const ASTContext &Context,
1400                                    const ConstantArrayType *CAT) {
1401   std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> EltInfo =
1402       Context.getTypeInfoInChars(CAT->getElementType());
1403   uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1404   assert((Size == 0 || static_cast<uint64_t>(EltInfo.first.getQuantity()) <=
1405               (uint64_t)(-1)/Size) &&
1406          "Overflow in array type char size evaluation");
1407   uint64_t Width = EltInfo.first.getQuantity() * Size;
1408   unsigned Align = EltInfo.second.getQuantity();
1409   if (!Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1410       Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1411     Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1412   return std::make_pair(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Width),
1413                         CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
1414 }
1415 
1416 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1417 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(const Type *T) const {
1418   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(T))
1419     return getConstantArrayInfoInChars(*this, CAT);
1420   TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(T);
1421   return std::make_pair(toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Width),
1422                         toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align));
1423 }
1424 
1425 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits>
1426 ASTContext::getTypeInfoInChars(QualType T) const {
1427   return getTypeInfoInChars(T.getTypePtr());
1428 }
1429 
1430 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(const Type *T) const {
1431   return getTypeInfo(T).AlignIsRequired;
1432 }
1433 
1434 bool ASTContext::isAlignmentRequired(QualType T) const {
1435   return isAlignmentRequired(T.getTypePtr());
1436 }
1437 
1438 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfo(const Type *T) const {
1439   TypeInfoMap::iterator I = MemoizedTypeInfo.find(T);
1440   if (I != MemoizedTypeInfo.end())
1441     return I->second;
1442 
1443   // This call can invalidate MemoizedTypeInfo[T], so we need a second lookup.
1444   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfoImpl(T);
1445   MemoizedTypeInfo[T] = TI;
1446   return TI;
1447 }
1448 
1449 /// getTypeInfoImpl - Return the size of the specified type, in bits.  This
1450 /// method does not work on incomplete types.
1451 ///
1452 /// FIXME: Pointers into different addr spaces could have different sizes and
1453 /// alignment requirements: getPointerInfo should take an AddrSpace, this
1454 /// should take a QualType, &c.
1455 TypeInfo ASTContext::getTypeInfoImpl(const Type *T) const {
1456   uint64_t Width = 0;
1457   unsigned Align = 8;
1458   bool AlignIsRequired = false;
1459   switch (T->getTypeClass()) {
1460 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
1461 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
1462 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base)
1463 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
1464 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base)                       \
1465   case Type::Class:                                                            \
1466   assert(!T->isDependentType() && "should not see dependent types here");      \
1467   return getTypeInfo(cast<Class##Type>(T)->desugar().getTypePtr());
1468 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
1469     llvm_unreachable("Should not see dependent types");
1470 
1471   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
1472   case Type::FunctionProto:
1473     // GCC extension: alignof(function) = 32 bits
1474     Width = 0;
1475     Align = 32;
1476     break;
1477 
1478   case Type::IncompleteArray:
1479   case Type::VariableArray:
1480     Width = 0;
1481     Align = getTypeAlign(cast<ArrayType>(T)->getElementType());
1482     break;
1483 
1484   case Type::ConstantArray: {
1485     const ConstantArrayType *CAT = cast<ConstantArrayType>(T);
1486 
1487     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(CAT->getElementType());
1488     uint64_t Size = CAT->getSize().getZExtValue();
1489     assert((Size == 0 || EltInfo.Width <= (uint64_t)(-1) / Size) &&
1490            "Overflow in array type bit size evaluation");
1491     Width = EltInfo.Width * Size;
1492     Align = EltInfo.Align;
1493     if (!getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() ||
1494         getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0) == 64)
1495       Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1496     break;
1497   }
1498   case Type::ExtVector:
1499   case Type::Vector: {
1500     const VectorType *VT = cast<VectorType>(T);
1501     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(VT->getElementType());
1502     Width = EltInfo.Width * VT->getNumElements();
1503     Align = Width;
1504     // If the alignment is not a power of 2, round up to the next power of 2.
1505     // This happens for non-power-of-2 length vectors.
1506     if (Align & (Align-1)) {
1507       Align = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Align);
1508       Width = llvm::RoundUpToAlignment(Width, Align);
1509     }
1510     // Adjust the alignment based on the target max.
1511     uint64_t TargetVectorAlign = Target->getMaxVectorAlign();
1512     if (TargetVectorAlign && TargetVectorAlign < Align)
1513       Align = TargetVectorAlign;
1514     break;
1515   }
1516 
1517   case Type::Builtin:
1518     switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
1519     default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type!");
1520     case BuiltinType::Void:
1521       // GCC extension: alignof(void) = 8 bits.
1522       Width = 0;
1523       Align = 8;
1524       break;
1525 
1526     case BuiltinType::Bool:
1527       Width = Target->getBoolWidth();
1528       Align = Target->getBoolAlign();
1529       break;
1530     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
1531     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
1532     case BuiltinType::UChar:
1533     case BuiltinType::SChar:
1534       Width = Target->getCharWidth();
1535       Align = Target->getCharAlign();
1536       break;
1537     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
1538     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
1539       Width = Target->getWCharWidth();
1540       Align = Target->getWCharAlign();
1541       break;
1542     case BuiltinType::Char16:
1543       Width = Target->getChar16Width();
1544       Align = Target->getChar16Align();
1545       break;
1546     case BuiltinType::Char32:
1547       Width = Target->getChar32Width();
1548       Align = Target->getChar32Align();
1549       break;
1550     case BuiltinType::UShort:
1551     case BuiltinType::Short:
1552       Width = Target->getShortWidth();
1553       Align = Target->getShortAlign();
1554       break;
1555     case BuiltinType::UInt:
1556     case BuiltinType::Int:
1557       Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1558       Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1559       break;
1560     case BuiltinType::ULong:
1561     case BuiltinType::Long:
1562       Width = Target->getLongWidth();
1563       Align = Target->getLongAlign();
1564       break;
1565     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
1566     case BuiltinType::LongLong:
1567       Width = Target->getLongLongWidth();
1568       Align = Target->getLongLongAlign();
1569       break;
1570     case BuiltinType::Int128:
1571     case BuiltinType::UInt128:
1572       Width = 128;
1573       Align = 128; // int128_t is 128-bit aligned on all targets.
1574       break;
1575     case BuiltinType::Half:
1576       Width = Target->getHalfWidth();
1577       Align = Target->getHalfAlign();
1578       break;
1579     case BuiltinType::Float:
1580       Width = Target->getFloatWidth();
1581       Align = Target->getFloatAlign();
1582       break;
1583     case BuiltinType::Double:
1584       Width = Target->getDoubleWidth();
1585       Align = Target->getDoubleAlign();
1586       break;
1587     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
1588       Width = Target->getLongDoubleWidth();
1589       Align = Target->getLongDoubleAlign();
1590       break;
1591     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:
1592       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0); // C++ 3.9.1p11: sizeof(nullptr_t)
1593       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0); //   == sizeof(void*)
1594       break;
1595     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
1596     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
1597     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
1598       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1599       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1600       break;
1601     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
1602       // Samplers are modeled as integers.
1603       Width = Target->getIntWidth();
1604       Align = Target->getIntAlign();
1605       break;
1606     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
1607     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
1608     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
1609     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
1610     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
1611     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
1612     case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
1613       // Currently these types are pointers to opaque types.
1614       Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1615       Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1616       break;
1617     }
1618     break;
1619   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
1620     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(0);
1621     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(0);
1622     break;
1623   case Type::BlockPointer: {
1624     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1625         cast<BlockPointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1626     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1627     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1628     break;
1629   }
1630   case Type::LValueReference:
1631   case Type::RValueReference: {
1632     // alignof and sizeof should never enter this code path here, so we go
1633     // the pointer route.
1634     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(
1635         cast<ReferenceType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1636     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1637     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1638     break;
1639   }
1640   case Type::Pointer: {
1641     unsigned AS = getTargetAddressSpace(cast<PointerType>(T)->getPointeeType());
1642     Width = Target->getPointerWidth(AS);
1643     Align = Target->getPointerAlign(AS);
1644     break;
1645   }
1646   case Type::MemberPointer: {
1647     const MemberPointerType *MPT = cast<MemberPointerType>(T);
1648     std::tie(Width, Align) = ABI->getMemberPointerWidthAndAlign(MPT);
1649     break;
1650   }
1651   case Type::Complex: {
1652     // Complex types have the same alignment as their elements, but twice the
1653     // size.
1654     TypeInfo EltInfo = getTypeInfo(cast<ComplexType>(T)->getElementType());
1655     Width = EltInfo.Width * 2;
1656     Align = EltInfo.Align;
1657     break;
1658   }
1659   case Type::ObjCObject:
1660     return getTypeInfo(cast<ObjCObjectType>(T)->getBaseType().getTypePtr());
1661   case Type::Adjusted:
1662   case Type::Decayed:
1663     return getTypeInfo(cast<AdjustedType>(T)->getAdjustedType().getTypePtr());
1664   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
1665     const ObjCInterfaceType *ObjCI = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(T);
1666     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(ObjCI->getDecl());
1667     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1668     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1669     break;
1670   }
1671   case Type::Record:
1672   case Type::Enum: {
1673     const TagType *TT = cast<TagType>(T);
1674 
1675     if (TT->getDecl()->isInvalidDecl()) {
1676       Width = 8;
1677       Align = 8;
1678       break;
1679     }
1680 
1681     if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(TT)) {
1682       const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl();
1683       TypeInfo Info =
1684           getTypeInfo(ED->getIntegerType()->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
1685       if (unsigned AttrAlign = ED->getMaxAlignment()) {
1686         Info.Align = AttrAlign;
1687         Info.AlignIsRequired = true;
1688       }
1689       return Info;
1690     }
1691 
1692     const RecordType *RT = cast<RecordType>(TT);
1693     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1694     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getASTRecordLayout(RD);
1695     Width = toBits(Layout.getSize());
1696     Align = toBits(Layout.getAlignment());
1697     AlignIsRequired = RD->hasAttr<AlignedAttr>();
1698     break;
1699   }
1700 
1701   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm:
1702     return getTypeInfo(cast<SubstTemplateTypeParmType>(T)->
1703                        getReplacementType().getTypePtr());
1704 
1705   case Type::Auto: {
1706     const AutoType *A = cast<AutoType>(T);
1707     assert(!A->getDeducedType().isNull() &&
1708            "cannot request the size of an undeduced or dependent auto type");
1709     return getTypeInfo(A->getDeducedType().getTypePtr());
1710   }
1711 
1712   case Type::Paren:
1713     return getTypeInfo(cast<ParenType>(T)->getInnerType().getTypePtr());
1714 
1715   case Type::Typedef: {
1716     const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = cast<TypedefType>(T)->getDecl();
1717     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(Typedef->getUnderlyingType().getTypePtr());
1718     // If the typedef has an aligned attribute on it, it overrides any computed
1719     // alignment we have.  This violates the GCC documentation (which says that
1720     // attribute(aligned) can only round up) but matches its implementation.
1721     if (unsigned AttrAlign = Typedef->getMaxAlignment()) {
1722       Align = AttrAlign;
1723       AlignIsRequired = true;
1724     } else {
1725       Align = Info.Align;
1726       AlignIsRequired = Info.AlignIsRequired;
1727     }
1728     Width = Info.Width;
1729     break;
1730   }
1731 
1732   case Type::Elaborated:
1733     return getTypeInfo(cast<ElaboratedType>(T)->getNamedType().getTypePtr());
1734 
1735   case Type::Attributed:
1736     return getTypeInfo(
1737                   cast<AttributedType>(T)->getEquivalentType().getTypePtr());
1738 
1739   case Type::Atomic: {
1740     // Start with the base type information.
1741     TypeInfo Info = getTypeInfo(cast<AtomicType>(T)->getValueType());
1742     Width = Info.Width;
1743     Align = Info.Align;
1744 
1745     // If the size of the type doesn't exceed the platform's max
1746     // atomic promotion width, make the size and alignment more
1747     // favorable to atomic operations:
1748     if (Width != 0 && Width <= Target->getMaxAtomicPromoteWidth()) {
1749       // Round the size up to a power of 2.
1750       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
1751         Width = llvm::NextPowerOf2(Width);
1752 
1753       // Set the alignment equal to the size.
1754       Align = static_cast<unsigned>(Width);
1755     }
1756   }
1757 
1758   }
1759 
1760   assert(llvm::isPowerOf2_32(Align) && "Alignment must be power of 2");
1761   return TypeInfo(Width, Align, AlignIsRequired);
1762 }
1763 
1764 /// toCharUnitsFromBits - Convert a size in bits to a size in characters.
1765 CharUnits ASTContext::toCharUnitsFromBits(int64_t BitSize) const {
1766   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(BitSize / getCharWidth());
1767 }
1768 
1769 /// toBits - Convert a size in characters to a size in characters.
1770 int64_t ASTContext::toBits(CharUnits CharSize) const {
1771   return CharSize.getQuantity() * getCharWidth();
1772 }
1773 
1774 /// getTypeSizeInChars - Return the size of the specified type, in characters.
1775 /// This method does not work on incomplete types.
1776 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(QualType T) const {
1777   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1778 }
1779 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeSizeInChars(const Type *T) const {
1780   return getTypeInfoInChars(T).first;
1781 }
1782 
1783 /// getTypeAlignInChars - Return the ABI-specified alignment of a type, in
1784 /// characters. This method does not work on incomplete types.
1785 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(QualType T) const {
1786   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1787 }
1788 CharUnits ASTContext::getTypeAlignInChars(const Type *T) const {
1789   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getTypeAlign(T));
1790 }
1791 
1792 /// getPreferredTypeAlign - Return the "preferred" alignment of the specified
1793 /// type for the current target in bits.  This can be different than the ABI
1794 /// alignment in cases where it is beneficial for performance to overalign
1795 /// a data type.
1796 unsigned ASTContext::getPreferredTypeAlign(const Type *T) const {
1797   TypeInfo TI = getTypeInfo(T);
1798   unsigned ABIAlign = TI.Align;
1799 
1800   T = T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1801 
1802   // The preferred alignment of member pointers is that of a pointer.
1803   if (T->isMemberPointerType())
1804     return getPreferredTypeAlign(getPointerDiffType().getTypePtr());
1805 
1806   if (Target->getTriple().getArch() == llvm::Triple::xcore)
1807     return ABIAlign;  // Never overalign on XCore.
1808 
1809   // Double and long long should be naturally aligned if possible.
1810   if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
1811     T = CT->getElementType().getTypePtr();
1812   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
1813     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
1814   if (T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double) ||
1815       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
1816       T->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong))
1817     // Don't increase the alignment if an alignment attribute was specified on a
1818     // typedef declaration.
1819     if (!TI.AlignIsRequired)
1820       return std::max(ABIAlign, (unsigned)getTypeSize(T));
1821 
1822   return ABIAlign;
1823 }
1824 
1825 /// getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned - Return the default alignment
1826 /// for __attribute__((aligned)) on this target, to be used if no alignment
1827 /// value is specified.
1828 unsigned ASTContext::getTargetDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned(void) const {
1829   return getTargetInfo().getDefaultAlignForAttributeAligned();
1830 }
1831 
1832 /// getAlignOfGlobalVar - Return the alignment in bits that should be given
1833 /// to a global variable of the specified type.
1834 unsigned ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVar(QualType T) const {
1835   return std::max(getTypeAlign(T), getTargetInfo().getMinGlobalAlign());
1836 }
1837 
1838 /// getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars - Return the alignment in characters that
1839 /// should be given to a global variable of the specified type.
1840 CharUnits ASTContext::getAlignOfGlobalVarInChars(QualType T) const {
1841   return toCharUnitsFromBits(getAlignOfGlobalVar(T));
1842 }
1843 
1844 /// DeepCollectObjCIvars -
1845 /// This routine first collects all declared, but not synthesized, ivars in
1846 /// super class and then collects all ivars, including those synthesized for
1847 /// current class. This routine is used for implementation of current class
1848 /// when all ivars, declared and synthesized are known.
1849 ///
1850 void ASTContext::DeepCollectObjCIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI,
1851                                       bool leafClass,
1852                             SmallVectorImpl<const ObjCIvarDecl*> &Ivars) const {
1853   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *SuperClass = OI->getSuperClass())
1854     DeepCollectObjCIvars(SuperClass, false, Ivars);
1855   if (!leafClass) {
1856     for (const auto *I : OI->ivars())
1857       Ivars.push_back(I);
1858   } else {
1859     ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = const_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl *>(OI);
1860     for (const ObjCIvarDecl *Iv = IDecl->all_declared_ivar_begin(); Iv;
1861          Iv= Iv->getNextIvar())
1862       Ivars.push_back(Iv);
1863   }
1864 }
1865 
1866 /// CollectInheritedProtocols - Collect all protocols in current class and
1867 /// those inherited by it.
1868 void ASTContext::CollectInheritedProtocols(const Decl *CDecl,
1869                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> &Protocols) {
1870   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CDecl)) {
1871     // We can use protocol_iterator here instead of
1872     // all_referenced_protocol_iterator since we are walking all categories.
1873     for (auto *Proto : OI->all_referenced_protocols()) {
1874       Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
1875       for (auto *P : Proto->protocols()) {
1876         Protocols.insert(P->getCanonicalDecl());
1877         CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
1878       }
1879     }
1880 
1881     // Categories of this Interface.
1882     for (const auto *Cat : OI->visible_categories())
1883       CollectInheritedProtocols(Cat, Protocols);
1884 
1885     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *SD = OI->getSuperClass())
1886       while (SD) {
1887         CollectInheritedProtocols(SD, Protocols);
1888         SD = SD->getSuperClass();
1889       }
1890   } else if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *OC = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CDecl)) {
1891     for (auto *Proto : OC->protocols()) {
1892       Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
1893       for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1894         CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
1895     }
1896   } else if (const ObjCProtocolDecl *OP = dyn_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl>(CDecl)) {
1897     for (auto *Proto : OP->protocols()) {
1898       Protocols.insert(Proto->getCanonicalDecl());
1899       for (const auto *P : Proto->protocols())
1900         CollectInheritedProtocols(P, Protocols);
1901     }
1902   }
1903 }
1904 
1905 unsigned ASTContext::CountNonClassIvars(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI) const {
1906   unsigned count = 0;
1907   // Count ivars declared in class extension.
1908   for (const auto *Ext : OI->known_extensions())
1909     count += Ext->ivar_size();
1910 
1911   // Count ivar defined in this class's implementation.  This
1912   // includes synthesized ivars.
1913   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplDecl = OI->getImplementation())
1914     count += ImplDecl->ivar_size();
1915 
1916   return count;
1917 }
1918 
1919 bool ASTContext::isSentinelNullExpr(const Expr *E) {
1920   if (!E)
1921     return false;
1922 
1923   // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
1924   if (E->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return true;
1925 
1926   if (E->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
1927       E->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(*this,
1928                                                 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
1929     return true;
1930 
1931   // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
1932   if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(E)) return true;
1933 
1934   return false;
1935 }
1936 
1937 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl,or NULL if none exists.
1938 ObjCImplementationDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) {
1939   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1940     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1941   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1942     return cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(I->second);
1943   return nullptr;
1944 }
1945 /// \brief Get the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl, or NULL if none exists.
1946 ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ASTContext::getObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *D) {
1947   llvm::DenseMap<ObjCContainerDecl*, ObjCImplDecl*>::iterator
1948     I = ObjCImpls.find(D);
1949   if (I != ObjCImpls.end())
1950     return cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(I->second);
1951   return nullptr;
1952 }
1953 
1954 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCInterfaceDecl.
1955 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFaceD,
1956                            ObjCImplementationDecl *ImplD) {
1957   assert(IFaceD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1958   ObjCImpls[IFaceD] = ImplD;
1959 }
1960 /// \brief Set the implementation of ObjCCategoryDecl.
1961 void ASTContext::setObjCImplementation(ObjCCategoryDecl *CatD,
1962                            ObjCCategoryImplDecl *ImplD) {
1963   assert(CatD && ImplD && "Passed null params");
1964   ObjCImpls[CatD] = ImplD;
1965 }
1966 
1967 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjContainingInterface(
1968                                               const NamedDecl *ND) const {
1969   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID =
1970           dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
1971     return ID;
1972   if (const ObjCCategoryDecl *CD =
1973           dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
1974     return CD->getClassInterface();
1975   if (const ObjCImplDecl *IMD =
1976           dyn_cast<ObjCImplDecl>(ND->getDeclContext()))
1977     return IMD->getClassInterface();
1978 
1979   return nullptr;
1980 }
1981 
1982 /// \brief Get the copy initialization expression of VarDecl,or NULL if
1983 /// none exists.
1984 Expr *ASTContext::getBlockVarCopyInits(const VarDecl*VD) {
1985   assert(VD && "Passed null params");
1986   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1987          "getBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
1988   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl*, Expr*>::iterator
1989     I = BlockVarCopyInits.find(VD);
1990   return (I != BlockVarCopyInits.end()) ? cast<Expr>(I->second) : nullptr;
1991 }
1992 
1993 /// \brief Set the copy inialization expression of a block var decl.
1994 void ASTContext::setBlockVarCopyInits(VarDecl*VD, Expr* Init) {
1995   assert(VD && Init && "Passed null params");
1996   assert(VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() &&
1997          "setBlockVarCopyInits - not __block var");
1998   BlockVarCopyInits[VD] = Init;
1999 }
2000 
2001 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::CreateTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2002                                                  unsigned DataSize) const {
2003   if (!DataSize)
2004     DataSize = TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T);
2005   else
2006     assert(DataSize == TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(T) &&
2007            "incorrect data size provided to CreateTypeSourceInfo!");
2008 
2009   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo =
2010     (TypeSourceInfo*)BumpAlloc.Allocate(sizeof(TypeSourceInfo) + DataSize, 8);
2011   new (TInfo) TypeSourceInfo(T);
2012   return TInfo;
2013 }
2014 
2015 TypeSourceInfo *ASTContext::getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(QualType T,
2016                                                      SourceLocation L) const {
2017   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(T);
2018   DI->getTypeLoc().initialize(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this), L);
2019   return DI;
2020 }
2021 
2022 const ASTRecordLayout &
2023 ASTContext::getASTObjCInterfaceLayout(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *D) const {
2024   return getObjCLayout(D, nullptr);
2025 }
2026 
2027 const ASTRecordLayout &
2028 ASTContext::getASTObjCImplementationLayout(
2029                                         const ObjCImplementationDecl *D) const {
2030   return getObjCLayout(D->getClassInterface(), D);
2031 }
2032 
2033 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2034 //                   Type creation/memoization methods
2035 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
2036 
2037 QualType
2038 ASTContext::getExtQualType(const Type *baseType, Qualifiers quals) const {
2039   unsigned fastQuals = quals.getFastQualifiers();
2040   quals.removeFastQualifiers();
2041 
2042   // Check if we've already instantiated this type.
2043   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2044   ExtQuals::Profile(ID, baseType, quals);
2045   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2046   if (ExtQuals *eq = ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos)) {
2047     assert(eq->getQualifiers() == quals);
2048     return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2049   }
2050 
2051   // If the base type is not canonical, make the appropriate canonical type.
2052   QualType canon;
2053   if (!baseType->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2054     SplitQualType canonSplit = baseType->getCanonicalTypeInternal().split();
2055     canonSplit.Quals.addConsistentQualifiers(quals);
2056     canon = getExtQualType(canonSplit.Ty, canonSplit.Quals);
2057 
2058     // Re-find the insert position.
2059     (void) ExtQualNodes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2060   }
2061 
2062   ExtQuals *eq = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ExtQuals(baseType, canon, quals);
2063   ExtQualNodes.InsertNode(eq, insertPos);
2064   return QualType(eq, fastQuals);
2065 }
2066 
2067 QualType
2068 ASTContext::getAddrSpaceQualType(QualType T, unsigned AddressSpace) const {
2069   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2070   if (CanT.getAddressSpace() == AddressSpace)
2071     return T;
2072 
2073   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2074   // into one ExtQuals node.
2075   QualifierCollector Quals;
2076   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2077 
2078   // If this type already has an address space specified, it cannot get
2079   // another one.
2080   assert(!Quals.hasAddressSpace() &&
2081          "Type cannot be in multiple addr spaces!");
2082   Quals.addAddressSpace(AddressSpace);
2083 
2084   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2085 }
2086 
2087 QualType ASTContext::getObjCGCQualType(QualType T,
2088                                        Qualifiers::GC GCAttr) const {
2089   QualType CanT = getCanonicalType(T);
2090   if (CanT.getObjCGCAttr() == GCAttr)
2091     return T;
2092 
2093   if (const PointerType *ptr = T->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2094     QualType Pointee = ptr->getPointeeType();
2095     if (Pointee->isAnyPointerType()) {
2096       QualType ResultType = getObjCGCQualType(Pointee, GCAttr);
2097       return getPointerType(ResultType);
2098     }
2099   }
2100 
2101   // If we are composing extended qualifiers together, merge together
2102   // into one ExtQuals node.
2103   QualifierCollector Quals;
2104   const Type *TypeNode = Quals.strip(T);
2105 
2106   // If this type already has an ObjCGC specified, it cannot get
2107   // another one.
2108   assert(!Quals.hasObjCGCAttr() &&
2109          "Type cannot have multiple ObjCGCs!");
2110   Quals.addObjCGCAttr(GCAttr);
2111 
2112   return getExtQualType(TypeNode, Quals);
2113 }
2114 
2115 const FunctionType *ASTContext::adjustFunctionType(const FunctionType *T,
2116                                                    FunctionType::ExtInfo Info) {
2117   if (T->getExtInfo() == Info)
2118     return T;
2119 
2120   QualType Result;
2121   if (const FunctionNoProtoType *FNPT = dyn_cast<FunctionNoProtoType>(T)) {
2122     Result = getFunctionNoProtoType(FNPT->getReturnType(), Info);
2123   } else {
2124     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(T);
2125     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2126     EPI.ExtInfo = Info;
2127     Result = getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
2128   }
2129 
2130   return cast<FunctionType>(Result.getTypePtr());
2131 }
2132 
2133 void ASTContext::adjustDeducedFunctionResultType(FunctionDecl *FD,
2134                                                  QualType ResultType) {
2135   FD = FD->getMostRecentDecl();
2136   while (true) {
2137     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2138     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
2139     FD->setType(getFunctionType(ResultType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
2140     if (FunctionDecl *Next = FD->getPreviousDecl())
2141       FD = Next;
2142     else
2143       break;
2144   }
2145   if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener())
2146     L->DeducedReturnType(FD, ResultType);
2147 }
2148 
2149 /// Get a function type and produce the equivalent function type with the
2150 /// specified exception specification. Type sugar that can be present on a
2151 /// declaration of a function with an exception specification is permitted
2152 /// and preserved. Other type sugar (for instance, typedefs) is not.
2153 static QualType getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(
2154     ASTContext &Context, QualType Orig,
2155     const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI) {
2156   // Might have some parens.
2157   if (auto *PT = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Orig))
2158     return Context.getParenType(
2159         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, PT->getInnerType(), ESI));
2160 
2161   // Might have a calling-convention attribute.
2162   if (auto *AT = dyn_cast<AttributedType>(Orig))
2163     return Context.getAttributedType(
2164         AT->getAttrKind(),
2165         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getModifiedType(), ESI),
2166         getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(Context, AT->getEquivalentType(),
2167                                          ESI));
2168 
2169   // Anything else must be a function type. Rebuild it with the new exception
2170   // specification.
2171   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Orig);
2172   return Context.getFunctionType(
2173       Proto->getReturnType(), Proto->getParamTypes(),
2174       Proto->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(ESI));
2175 }
2176 
2177 void ASTContext::adjustExceptionSpec(
2178     FunctionDecl *FD, const FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo &ESI,
2179     bool AsWritten) {
2180   // Update the type.
2181   QualType Updated =
2182       getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, FD->getType(), ESI);
2183   FD->setType(Updated);
2184 
2185   if (!AsWritten)
2186     return;
2187 
2188   // Update the type in the type source information too.
2189   if (TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
2190     // If the type and the type-as-written differ, we may need to update
2191     // the type-as-written too.
2192     if (TSInfo->getType() != FD->getType())
2193       Updated = getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(*this, TSInfo->getType(), ESI);
2194 
2195     // FIXME: When we get proper type location information for exceptions,
2196     // we'll also have to rebuild the TypeSourceInfo. For now, we just patch
2197     // up the TypeSourceInfo;
2198     assert(TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(Updated) ==
2199                TypeLoc::getFullDataSizeForType(TSInfo->getType()) &&
2200            "TypeLoc size mismatch from updating exception specification");
2201     TSInfo->overrideType(Updated);
2202   }
2203 }
2204 
2205 /// getComplexType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a complex
2206 /// number with the specified element type.
2207 QualType ASTContext::getComplexType(QualType T) const {
2208   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2209   // structure.
2210   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2211   ComplexType::Profile(ID, T);
2212 
2213   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2214   if (ComplexType *CT = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2215     return QualType(CT, 0);
2216 
2217   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2218   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2219   QualType Canonical;
2220   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2221     Canonical = getComplexType(getCanonicalType(T));
2222 
2223     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2224     ComplexType *NewIP = ComplexTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2225     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2226   }
2227   ComplexType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ComplexType(T, Canonical);
2228   Types.push_back(New);
2229   ComplexTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2230   return QualType(New, 0);
2231 }
2232 
2233 /// getPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a pointer to
2234 /// the specified type.
2235 QualType ASTContext::getPointerType(QualType T) const {
2236   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2237   // structure.
2238   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2239   PointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2240 
2241   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2242   if (PointerType *PT = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2243     return QualType(PT, 0);
2244 
2245   // If the pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2246   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2247   QualType Canonical;
2248   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2249     Canonical = getPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2250 
2251     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2252     PointerType *NewIP = PointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2253     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2254   }
2255   PointerType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) PointerType(T, Canonical);
2256   Types.push_back(New);
2257   PointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2258   return QualType(New, 0);
2259 }
2260 
2261 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedType(QualType Orig, QualType New) const {
2262   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2263   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, Orig, New);
2264   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2265   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2266   if (AT)
2267     return QualType(AT, 0);
2268 
2269   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(New);
2270 
2271   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2272   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2273   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2274 
2275   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2276       AdjustedType(Type::Adjusted, Orig, New, Canonical);
2277   Types.push_back(AT);
2278   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2279   return QualType(AT, 0);
2280 }
2281 
2282 QualType ASTContext::getDecayedType(QualType T) const {
2283   assert((T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType()) && "T does not decay");
2284 
2285   QualType Decayed;
2286 
2287   // C99 6.7.5.3p7:
2288   //   A declaration of a parameter as "array of type" shall be
2289   //   adjusted to "qualified pointer to type", where the type
2290   //   qualifiers (if any) are those specified within the [ and ] of
2291   //   the array type derivation.
2292   if (T->isArrayType())
2293     Decayed = getArrayDecayedType(T);
2294 
2295   // C99 6.7.5.3p8:
2296   //   A declaration of a parameter as "function returning type"
2297   //   shall be adjusted to "pointer to function returning type", as
2298   //   in 6.3.2.1.
2299   if (T->isFunctionType())
2300     Decayed = getPointerType(T);
2301 
2302   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2303   AdjustedType::Profile(ID, T, Decayed);
2304   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2305   AdjustedType *AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2306   if (AT)
2307     return QualType(AT, 0);
2308 
2309   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decayed);
2310 
2311   // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2312   AT = AdjustedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2313   assert(!AT && "Shouldn't be in the map!");
2314 
2315   AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DecayedType(T, Decayed, Canonical);
2316   Types.push_back(AT);
2317   AdjustedTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
2318   return QualType(AT, 0);
2319 }
2320 
2321 /// getBlockPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for
2322 /// a pointer to the specified block.
2323 QualType ASTContext::getBlockPointerType(QualType T) const {
2324   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "block of function types only");
2325   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one block of a particular
2326   // structure.
2327   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2328   BlockPointerType::Profile(ID, T);
2329 
2330   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2331   if (BlockPointerType *PT =
2332         BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2333     return QualType(PT, 0);
2334 
2335   // If the block pointee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2336   // type either so fill in the canonical type field.
2337   QualType Canonical;
2338   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
2339     Canonical = getBlockPointerType(getCanonicalType(T));
2340 
2341     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2342     BlockPointerType *NewIP =
2343       BlockPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2344     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2345   }
2346   BlockPointerType *New
2347     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) BlockPointerType(T, Canonical);
2348   Types.push_back(New);
2349   BlockPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2350   return QualType(New, 0);
2351 }
2352 
2353 /// getLValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2354 /// lvalue reference to the specified type.
2355 QualType
2356 ASTContext::getLValueReferenceType(QualType T, bool SpelledAsLValue) const {
2357   assert(getCanonicalType(T) != OverloadTy &&
2358          "Unresolved overloaded function type");
2359 
2360   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2361   // structure.
2362   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2363   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, SpelledAsLValue);
2364 
2365   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2366   if (LValueReferenceType *RT =
2367         LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2368     return QualType(RT, 0);
2369 
2370   const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2371 
2372   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2373   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2374   QualType Canonical;
2375   if (!SpelledAsLValue || InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2376     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2377     Canonical = getLValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2378 
2379     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2380     LValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2381       LValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2382     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2383   }
2384 
2385   LValueReferenceType *New
2386     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) LValueReferenceType(T, Canonical,
2387                                                      SpelledAsLValue);
2388   Types.push_back(New);
2389   LValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2390 
2391   return QualType(New, 0);
2392 }
2393 
2394 /// getRValueReferenceType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for an
2395 /// rvalue reference to the specified type.
2396 QualType ASTContext::getRValueReferenceType(QualType T) const {
2397   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2398   // structure.
2399   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2400   ReferenceType::Profile(ID, T, false);
2401 
2402   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2403   if (RValueReferenceType *RT =
2404         RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2405     return QualType(RT, 0);
2406 
2407   const ReferenceType *InnerRef = T->getAs<ReferenceType>();
2408 
2409   // If the referencee type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2410   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2411   QualType Canonical;
2412   if (InnerRef || !T.isCanonical()) {
2413     QualType PointeeType = (InnerRef ? InnerRef->getPointeeType() : T);
2414     Canonical = getRValueReferenceType(getCanonicalType(PointeeType));
2415 
2416     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2417     RValueReferenceType *NewIP =
2418       RValueReferenceTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2419     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2420   }
2421 
2422   RValueReferenceType *New
2423     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RValueReferenceType(T, Canonical);
2424   Types.push_back(New);
2425   RValueReferenceTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2426   return QualType(New, 0);
2427 }
2428 
2429 /// getMemberPointerType - Return the uniqued reference to the type for a
2430 /// member pointer to the specified type, in the specified class.
2431 QualType ASTContext::getMemberPointerType(QualType T, const Type *Cls) const {
2432   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
2433   // structure.
2434   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2435   MemberPointerType::Profile(ID, T, Cls);
2436 
2437   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2438   if (MemberPointerType *PT =
2439       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2440     return QualType(PT, 0);
2441 
2442   // If the pointee or class type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical
2443   // type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2444   QualType Canonical;
2445   if (!T.isCanonical() || !Cls->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
2446     Canonical = getMemberPointerType(getCanonicalType(T),getCanonicalType(Cls));
2447 
2448     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2449     MemberPointerType *NewIP =
2450       MemberPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2451     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2452   }
2453   MemberPointerType *New
2454     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) MemberPointerType(T, Cls, Canonical);
2455   Types.push_back(New);
2456   MemberPointerTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2457   return QualType(New, 0);
2458 }
2459 
2460 /// getConstantArrayType - Return the unique reference to the type for an
2461 /// array of the specified element type.
2462 QualType ASTContext::getConstantArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2463                                           const llvm::APInt &ArySizeIn,
2464                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2465                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals) const {
2466   assert((EltTy->isDependentType() ||
2467           EltTy->isIncompleteType() || EltTy->isConstantSizeType()) &&
2468          "Constant array of VLAs is illegal!");
2469 
2470   // Convert the array size into a canonical width matching the pointer size for
2471   // the target.
2472   llvm::APInt ArySize(ArySizeIn);
2473   ArySize =
2474     ArySize.zextOrTrunc(Target->getPointerWidth(getTargetAddressSpace(EltTy)));
2475 
2476   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2477   ConstantArrayType::Profile(ID, EltTy, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2478 
2479   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2480   if (ConstantArrayType *ATP =
2481       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2482     return QualType(ATP, 0);
2483 
2484   // If the element type isn't canonical or has qualifiers, this won't
2485   // be a canonical type either, so fill in the canonical type field.
2486   QualType Canon;
2487   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2488     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2489     Canon = getConstantArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), ArySize,
2490                                  ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2491     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2492 
2493     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2494     ConstantArrayType *NewIP =
2495       ConstantArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2496     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2497   }
2498 
2499   ConstantArrayType *New = new(*this,TypeAlignment)
2500     ConstantArrayType(EltTy, Canon, ArySize, ASM, IndexTypeQuals);
2501   ConstantArrayTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2502   Types.push_back(New);
2503   return QualType(New, 0);
2504 }
2505 
2506 /// getVariableArrayDecayedType - Turns the given type, which may be
2507 /// variably-modified, into the corresponding type with all the known
2508 /// sizes replaced with [*].
2509 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayDecayedType(QualType type) const {
2510   // Vastly most common case.
2511   if (!type->isVariablyModifiedType()) return type;
2512 
2513   QualType result;
2514 
2515   SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
2516   const Type *ty = split.Ty;
2517   switch (ty->getTypeClass()) {
2518 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
2519 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
2520 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
2521 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
2522     llvm_unreachable("didn't desugar past all non-canonical types?");
2523 
2524   // These types should never be variably-modified.
2525   case Type::Builtin:
2526   case Type::Complex:
2527   case Type::Vector:
2528   case Type::ExtVector:
2529   case Type::DependentSizedExtVector:
2530   case Type::ObjCObject:
2531   case Type::ObjCInterface:
2532   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer:
2533   case Type::Record:
2534   case Type::Enum:
2535   case Type::UnresolvedUsing:
2536   case Type::TypeOfExpr:
2537   case Type::TypeOf:
2538   case Type::Decltype:
2539   case Type::UnaryTransform:
2540   case Type::DependentName:
2541   case Type::InjectedClassName:
2542   case Type::TemplateSpecialization:
2543   case Type::DependentTemplateSpecialization:
2544   case Type::TemplateTypeParm:
2545   case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParmPack:
2546   case Type::Auto:
2547   case Type::PackExpansion:
2548     llvm_unreachable("type should never be variably-modified");
2549 
2550   // These types can be variably-modified but should never need to
2551   // further decay.
2552   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
2553   case Type::FunctionProto:
2554   case Type::BlockPointer:
2555   case Type::MemberPointer:
2556     return type;
2557 
2558   // These types can be variably-modified.  All these modifications
2559   // preserve structure except as noted by comments.
2560   // TODO: if we ever care about optimizing VLAs, there are no-op
2561   // optimizations available here.
2562   case Type::Pointer:
2563     result = getPointerType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(
2564                               cast<PointerType>(ty)->getPointeeType()));
2565     break;
2566 
2567   case Type::LValueReference: {
2568     const LValueReferenceType *lv = cast<LValueReferenceType>(ty);
2569     result = getLValueReferenceType(
2570                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()),
2571                                     lv->isSpelledAsLValue());
2572     break;
2573   }
2574 
2575   case Type::RValueReference: {
2576     const RValueReferenceType *lv = cast<RValueReferenceType>(ty);
2577     result = getRValueReferenceType(
2578                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(lv->getPointeeType()));
2579     break;
2580   }
2581 
2582   case Type::Atomic: {
2583     const AtomicType *at = cast<AtomicType>(ty);
2584     result = getAtomicType(getVariableArrayDecayedType(at->getValueType()));
2585     break;
2586   }
2587 
2588   case Type::ConstantArray: {
2589     const ConstantArrayType *cat = cast<ConstantArrayType>(ty);
2590     result = getConstantArrayType(
2591                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(cat->getElementType()),
2592                                   cat->getSize(),
2593                                   cat->getSizeModifier(),
2594                                   cat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers());
2595     break;
2596   }
2597 
2598   case Type::DependentSizedArray: {
2599     const DependentSizedArrayType *dat = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ty);
2600     result = getDependentSizedArrayType(
2601                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(dat->getElementType()),
2602                                         dat->getSizeExpr(),
2603                                         dat->getSizeModifier(),
2604                                         dat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2605                                         dat->getBracketsRange());
2606     break;
2607   }
2608 
2609   // Turn incomplete types into [*] types.
2610   case Type::IncompleteArray: {
2611     const IncompleteArrayType *iat = cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ty);
2612     result = getVariableArrayType(
2613                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(iat->getElementType()),
2614                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
2615                                   ArrayType::Normal,
2616                                   iat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2617                                   SourceRange());
2618     break;
2619   }
2620 
2621   // Turn VLA types into [*] types.
2622   case Type::VariableArray: {
2623     const VariableArrayType *vat = cast<VariableArrayType>(ty);
2624     result = getVariableArrayType(
2625                  getVariableArrayDecayedType(vat->getElementType()),
2626                                   /*size*/ nullptr,
2627                                   ArrayType::Star,
2628                                   vat->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
2629                                   vat->getBracketsRange());
2630     break;
2631   }
2632   }
2633 
2634   // Apply the top-level qualifiers from the original.
2635   return getQualifiedType(result, split.Quals);
2636 }
2637 
2638 /// getVariableArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to the type for a
2639 /// variable array of the specified element type.
2640 QualType ASTContext::getVariableArrayType(QualType EltTy,
2641                                           Expr *NumElts,
2642                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2643                                           unsigned IndexTypeQuals,
2644                                           SourceRange Brackets) const {
2645   // Since we don't unique expressions, it isn't possible to unique VLA's
2646   // that have an expression provided for their size.
2647   QualType Canon;
2648 
2649   // Be sure to pull qualifiers off the element type.
2650   if (!EltTy.isCanonical() || EltTy.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2651     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(EltTy).split();
2652     Canon = getVariableArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0), NumElts, ASM,
2653                                  IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2654     Canon = getQualifiedType(Canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2655   }
2656 
2657   VariableArrayType *New = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
2658     VariableArrayType(EltTy, Canon, NumElts, ASM, IndexTypeQuals, Brackets);
2659 
2660   VariableArrayTypes.push_back(New);
2661   Types.push_back(New);
2662   return QualType(New, 0);
2663 }
2664 
2665 /// getDependentSizedArrayType - Returns a non-unique reference to
2666 /// the type for a dependently-sized array of the specified element
2667 /// type.
2668 QualType ASTContext::getDependentSizedArrayType(QualType elementType,
2669                                                 Expr *numElements,
2670                                                 ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2671                                                 unsigned elementTypeQuals,
2672                                                 SourceRange brackets) const {
2673   assert((!numElements || numElements->isTypeDependent() ||
2674           numElements->isValueDependent()) &&
2675          "Size must be type- or value-dependent!");
2676 
2677   // Dependently-sized array types that do not have a specified number
2678   // of elements will have their sizes deduced from a dependent
2679   // initializer.  We do no canonicalization here at all, which is okay
2680   // because they can't be used in most locations.
2681   if (!numElements) {
2682     DependentSizedArrayType *newType
2683       = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2684           DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, QualType(),
2685                                   numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2686                                   brackets);
2687     Types.push_back(newType);
2688     return QualType(newType, 0);
2689   }
2690 
2691   // Otherwise, we actually build a new type every time, but we
2692   // also build a canonical type.
2693 
2694   SplitQualType canonElementType = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2695 
2696   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2697   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2698   DependentSizedArrayType::Profile(ID, *this,
2699                                    QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2700                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals, numElements);
2701 
2702   // Look for an existing type with these properties.
2703   DependentSizedArrayType *canonTy =
2704     DependentSizedArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2705 
2706   // If we don't have one, build one.
2707   if (!canonTy) {
2708     canonTy = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2709       DependentSizedArrayType(*this, QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0),
2710                               QualType(), numElements, ASM, elementTypeQuals,
2711                               brackets);
2712     DependentSizedArrayTypes.InsertNode(canonTy, insertPos);
2713     Types.push_back(canonTy);
2714   }
2715 
2716   // Apply qualifiers from the element type to the array.
2717   QualType canon = getQualifiedType(QualType(canonTy,0),
2718                                     canonElementType.Quals);
2719 
2720   // If we didn't need extra canonicalization for the element type,
2721   // then just use that as our result.
2722   if (QualType(canonElementType.Ty, 0) == elementType)
2723     return canon;
2724 
2725   // Otherwise, we need to build a type which follows the spelling
2726   // of the element type.
2727   DependentSizedArrayType *sugaredType
2728     = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2729         DependentSizedArrayType(*this, elementType, canon, numElements,
2730                                 ASM, elementTypeQuals, brackets);
2731   Types.push_back(sugaredType);
2732   return QualType(sugaredType, 0);
2733 }
2734 
2735 QualType ASTContext::getIncompleteArrayType(QualType elementType,
2736                                             ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier ASM,
2737                                             unsigned elementTypeQuals) const {
2738   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2739   IncompleteArrayType::Profile(ID, elementType, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2740 
2741   void *insertPos = nullptr;
2742   if (IncompleteArrayType *iat =
2743        IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos))
2744     return QualType(iat, 0);
2745 
2746   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
2747   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.  We also have to pull
2748   // qualifiers off the element type.
2749   QualType canon;
2750 
2751   if (!elementType.isCanonical() || elementType.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
2752     SplitQualType canonSplit = getCanonicalType(elementType).split();
2753     canon = getIncompleteArrayType(QualType(canonSplit.Ty, 0),
2754                                    ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2755     canon = getQualifiedType(canon, canonSplit.Quals);
2756 
2757     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2758     IncompleteArrayType *existing =
2759       IncompleteArrayTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
2760     assert(!existing && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void) existing;
2761   }
2762 
2763   IncompleteArrayType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2764     IncompleteArrayType(elementType, canon, ASM, elementTypeQuals);
2765 
2766   IncompleteArrayTypes.InsertNode(newType, insertPos);
2767   Types.push_back(newType);
2768   return QualType(newType, 0);
2769 }
2770 
2771 /// getVectorType - Return the unique reference to a vector type of
2772 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
2773 QualType ASTContext::getVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts,
2774                                    VectorType::VectorKind VecKind) const {
2775   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType());
2776 
2777   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2778   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2779   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::Vector, VecKind);
2780 
2781   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2782   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2783     return QualType(VTP, 0);
2784 
2785   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2786   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2787   QualType Canonical;
2788   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2789     Canonical = getVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts, VecKind);
2790 
2791     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2792     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2793     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2794   }
2795   VectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2796     VectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical, VecKind);
2797   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2798   Types.push_back(New);
2799   return QualType(New, 0);
2800 }
2801 
2802 /// getExtVectorType - Return the unique reference to an extended vector type of
2803 /// the specified element type and size. VectorType must be a built-in type.
2804 QualType
2805 ASTContext::getExtVectorType(QualType vecType, unsigned NumElts) const {
2806   assert(vecType->isBuiltinType() || vecType->isDependentType());
2807 
2808   // Check if we've already instantiated a vector of this type.
2809   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2810   VectorType::Profile(ID, vecType, NumElts, Type::ExtVector,
2811                       VectorType::GenericVector);
2812   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2813   if (VectorType *VTP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2814     return QualType(VTP, 0);
2815 
2816   // If the element type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type either,
2817   // so fill in the canonical type field.
2818   QualType Canonical;
2819   if (!vecType.isCanonical()) {
2820     Canonical = getExtVectorType(getCanonicalType(vecType), NumElts);
2821 
2822     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2823     VectorType *NewIP = VectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2824     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2825   }
2826   ExtVectorType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2827     ExtVectorType(vecType, NumElts, Canonical);
2828   VectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2829   Types.push_back(New);
2830   return QualType(New, 0);
2831 }
2832 
2833 QualType
2834 ASTContext::getDependentSizedExtVectorType(QualType vecType,
2835                                            Expr *SizeExpr,
2836                                            SourceLocation AttrLoc) const {
2837   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2838   DependentSizedExtVectorType::Profile(ID, *this, getCanonicalType(vecType),
2839                                        SizeExpr);
2840 
2841   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2842   DependentSizedExtVectorType *Canon
2843     = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2844   DependentSizedExtVectorType *New;
2845   if (Canon) {
2846     // We already have a canonical version of this array type; use it as
2847     // the canonical type for a newly-built type.
2848     New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2849       DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(Canon, 0),
2850                                   SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2851   } else {
2852     QualType CanonVecTy = getCanonicalType(vecType);
2853     if (CanonVecTy == vecType) {
2854       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2855         DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, QualType(), SizeExpr,
2856                                     AttrLoc);
2857 
2858       DependentSizedExtVectorType *CanonCheck
2859         = DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2860       assert(!CanonCheck && "Dependent-sized ext_vector canonical type broken");
2861       (void)CanonCheck;
2862       DependentSizedExtVectorTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2863     } else {
2864       QualType Canon = getDependentSizedExtVectorType(CanonVecTy, SizeExpr,
2865                                                       SourceLocation());
2866       New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2867         DependentSizedExtVectorType(*this, vecType, Canon, SizeExpr, AttrLoc);
2868     }
2869   }
2870 
2871   Types.push_back(New);
2872   return QualType(New, 0);
2873 }
2874 
2875 /// getFunctionNoProtoType - Return a K&R style C function type like 'int()'.
2876 ///
2877 QualType
2878 ASTContext::getFunctionNoProtoType(QualType ResultTy,
2879                                    const FunctionType::ExtInfo &Info) const {
2880   const CallingConv CallConv = Info.getCC();
2881 
2882   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2883   // structure.
2884   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2885   FunctionNoProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, Info);
2886 
2887   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2888   if (FunctionNoProtoType *FT =
2889         FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2890     return QualType(FT, 0);
2891 
2892   QualType Canonical;
2893   if (!ResultTy.isCanonical()) {
2894     Canonical = getFunctionNoProtoType(getCanonicalType(ResultTy), Info);
2895 
2896     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2897     FunctionNoProtoType *NewIP =
2898       FunctionNoProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2899     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2900   }
2901 
2902   FunctionProtoType::ExtInfo newInfo = Info.withCallingConv(CallConv);
2903   FunctionNoProtoType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
2904     FunctionNoProtoType(ResultTy, Canonical, newInfo);
2905   Types.push_back(New);
2906   FunctionNoProtoTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
2907   return QualType(New, 0);
2908 }
2909 
2910 /// \brief Determine whether \p T is canonical as the result type of a function.
2911 static bool isCanonicalResultType(QualType T) {
2912   return T.isCanonical() &&
2913          (T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None ||
2914           T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone);
2915 }
2916 
2917 QualType
2918 ASTContext::getFunctionType(QualType ResultTy, ArrayRef<QualType> ArgArray,
2919                             const FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo &EPI) const {
2920   size_t NumArgs = ArgArray.size();
2921 
2922   // Unique functions, to guarantee there is only one function of a particular
2923   // structure.
2924   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
2925   FunctionProtoType::Profile(ID, ResultTy, ArgArray.begin(), NumArgs, EPI,
2926                              *this);
2927 
2928   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
2929   if (FunctionProtoType *FTP =
2930         FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
2931     return QualType(FTP, 0);
2932 
2933   // Determine whether the type being created is already canonical or not.
2934   bool isCanonical =
2935     EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_None && isCanonicalResultType(ResultTy) &&
2936     !EPI.HasTrailingReturn;
2937   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs && isCanonical; ++i)
2938     if (!ArgArray[i].isCanonicalAsParam())
2939       isCanonical = false;
2940 
2941   // If this type isn't canonical, get the canonical version of it.
2942   // The exception spec is not part of the canonical type.
2943   QualType Canonical;
2944   if (!isCanonical) {
2945     SmallVector<QualType, 16> CanonicalArgs;
2946     CanonicalArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
2947     for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
2948       CanonicalArgs.push_back(getCanonicalParamType(ArgArray[i]));
2949 
2950     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo CanonicalEPI = EPI;
2951     CanonicalEPI.HasTrailingReturn = false;
2952     CanonicalEPI.ExceptionSpec = FunctionProtoType::ExceptionSpecInfo();
2953 
2954     // Result types do not have ARC lifetime qualifiers.
2955     QualType CanResultTy = getCanonicalType(ResultTy);
2956     if (ResultTy.getQualifiers().hasObjCLifetime()) {
2957       Qualifiers Qs = CanResultTy.getQualifiers();
2958       Qs.removeObjCLifetime();
2959       CanResultTy = getQualifiedType(CanResultTy.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2960     }
2961 
2962     Canonical = getFunctionType(CanResultTy, CanonicalArgs, CanonicalEPI);
2963 
2964     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
2965     FunctionProtoType *NewIP =
2966       FunctionProtoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
2967     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
2968   }
2969 
2970   // FunctionProtoType objects are allocated with extra bytes after
2971   // them for three variable size arrays at the end:
2972   //  - parameter types
2973   //  - exception types
2974   //  - consumed-arguments flags
2975   // Instead of the exception types, there could be a noexcept
2976   // expression, or information used to resolve the exception
2977   // specification.
2978   size_t Size = sizeof(FunctionProtoType) +
2979                 NumArgs * sizeof(QualType);
2980   if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Dynamic) {
2981     Size += EPI.ExceptionSpec.Exceptions.size() * sizeof(QualType);
2982   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_ComputedNoexcept) {
2983     Size += sizeof(Expr*);
2984   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Uninstantiated) {
2985     Size += 2 * sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
2986   } else if (EPI.ExceptionSpec.Type == EST_Unevaluated) {
2987     Size += sizeof(FunctionDecl*);
2988   }
2989   if (EPI.ConsumedParameters)
2990     Size += NumArgs * sizeof(bool);
2991 
2992   FunctionProtoType *FTP = (FunctionProtoType*) Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
2993   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo newEPI = EPI;
2994   new (FTP) FunctionProtoType(ResultTy, ArgArray, Canonical, newEPI);
2995   Types.push_back(FTP);
2996   FunctionProtoTypes.InsertNode(FTP, InsertPos);
2997   return QualType(FTP, 0);
2998 }
2999 
3000 #ifndef NDEBUG
3001 static bool NeedsInjectedClassNameType(const RecordDecl *D) {
3002   if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(D)) return false;
3003   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
3004   if (isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3005     return true;
3006   if (RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() &&
3007       !isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD))
3008     return true;
3009   return false;
3010 }
3011 #endif
3012 
3013 /// getInjectedClassNameType - Return the unique reference to the
3014 /// injected class name type for the specified templated declaration.
3015 QualType ASTContext::getInjectedClassNameType(CXXRecordDecl *Decl,
3016                                               QualType TST) const {
3017   assert(NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Decl));
3018   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) {
3019     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3020   } else if (CXXRecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl()) {
3021     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous declaration has no type");
3022     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3023     assert(isa<InjectedClassNameType>(Decl->TypeForDecl));
3024   } else {
3025     Type *newType =
3026       new (*this, TypeAlignment) InjectedClassNameType(Decl, TST);
3027     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3028     Types.push_back(newType);
3029   }
3030   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3031 }
3032 
3033 /// getTypeDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3034 /// specified type declaration.
3035 QualType ASTContext::getTypeDeclTypeSlow(const TypeDecl *Decl) const {
3036   assert(Decl && "Passed null for Decl param");
3037   assert(!Decl->TypeForDecl && "TypeForDecl present in slow case");
3038 
3039   if (const TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Decl))
3040     return getTypedefType(Typedef);
3041 
3042   assert(!isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(Decl) &&
3043          "Template type parameter types are always available.");
3044 
3045   if (const RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Decl)) {
3046     assert(Record->isFirstDecl() && "struct/union has previous declaration");
3047     assert(!NeedsInjectedClassNameType(Record));
3048     return getRecordType(Record);
3049   } else if (const EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Decl)) {
3050     assert(Enum->isFirstDecl() && "enum has previous declaration");
3051     return getEnumType(Enum);
3052   } else if (const UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl *Using =
3053                dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(Decl)) {
3054     Type *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnresolvedUsingType(Using);
3055     Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3056     Types.push_back(newType);
3057   } else
3058     llvm_unreachable("TypeDecl without a type?");
3059 
3060   return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3061 }
3062 
3063 /// getTypedefType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3064 /// specified typedef name decl.
3065 QualType
3066 ASTContext::getTypedefType(const TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
3067                            QualType Canonical) const {
3068   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3069 
3070   if (Canonical.isNull())
3071     Canonical = getCanonicalType(Decl->getUnderlyingType());
3072   TypedefType *newType = new(*this, TypeAlignment)
3073     TypedefType(Type::Typedef, Decl, Canonical);
3074   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3075   Types.push_back(newType);
3076   return QualType(newType, 0);
3077 }
3078 
3079 QualType ASTContext::getRecordType(const RecordDecl *Decl) const {
3080   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3081 
3082   if (const RecordDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3083     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3084       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3085 
3086   RecordType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) RecordType(Decl);
3087   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3088   Types.push_back(newType);
3089   return QualType(newType, 0);
3090 }
3091 
3092 QualType ASTContext::getEnumType(const EnumDecl *Decl) const {
3093   if (Decl->TypeForDecl) return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3094 
3095   if (const EnumDecl *PrevDecl = Decl->getPreviousDecl())
3096     if (PrevDecl->TypeForDecl)
3097       return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3098 
3099   EnumType *newType = new (*this, TypeAlignment) EnumType(Decl);
3100   Decl->TypeForDecl = newType;
3101   Types.push_back(newType);
3102   return QualType(newType, 0);
3103 }
3104 
3105 QualType ASTContext::getAttributedType(AttributedType::Kind attrKind,
3106                                        QualType modifiedType,
3107                                        QualType equivalentType) {
3108   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID id;
3109   AttributedType::Profile(id, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3110 
3111   void *insertPos = nullptr;
3112   AttributedType *type = AttributedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(id, insertPos);
3113   if (type) return QualType(type, 0);
3114 
3115   QualType canon = getCanonicalType(equivalentType);
3116   type = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3117            AttributedType(canon, attrKind, modifiedType, equivalentType);
3118 
3119   Types.push_back(type);
3120   AttributedTypes.InsertNode(type, insertPos);
3121 
3122   return QualType(type, 0);
3123 }
3124 
3125 
3126 /// \brief Retrieve a substitution-result type.
3127 QualType
3128 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmType(const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3129                                          QualType Replacement) const {
3130   assert(Replacement.isCanonical()
3131          && "replacement types must always be canonical");
3132 
3133   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3134   SubstTemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Parm, Replacement);
3135   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3136   SubstTemplateTypeParmType *SubstParm
3137     = SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3138 
3139   if (!SubstParm) {
3140     SubstParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3141       SubstTemplateTypeParmType(Parm, Replacement);
3142     Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3143     SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3144   }
3145 
3146   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3147 }
3148 
3149 /// \brief Retrieve a
3150 QualType ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(
3151                                           const TemplateTypeParmType *Parm,
3152                                               const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) {
3153 #ifndef NDEBUG
3154   for (const auto &P : ArgPack.pack_elements()) {
3155     assert(P.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Type &&"Pack contains a non-type");
3156     assert(P.getAsType().isCanonical() && "Pack contains non-canonical type");
3157   }
3158 #endif
3159 
3160   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3161   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType::Profile(ID, Parm, ArgPack);
3162   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3163   if (SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3164         = SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3165     return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3166 
3167   QualType Canon;
3168   if (!Parm->isCanonicalUnqualified()) {
3169     Canon = getCanonicalType(QualType(Parm, 0));
3170     Canon = getSubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(cast<TemplateTypeParmType>(Canon),
3171                                              ArgPack);
3172     SubstTemplateTypeParmPackTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3173   }
3174 
3175   SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType *SubstParm
3176     = new (*this, TypeAlignment) SubstTemplateTypeParmPackType(Parm, Canon,
3177                                                                ArgPack);
3178   Types.push_back(SubstParm);
3179   SubstTemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(SubstParm, InsertPos);
3180   return QualType(SubstParm, 0);
3181 }
3182 
3183 /// \brief Retrieve the template type parameter type for a template
3184 /// parameter or parameter pack with the given depth, index, and (optionally)
3185 /// name.
3186 QualType ASTContext::getTemplateTypeParmType(unsigned Depth, unsigned Index,
3187                                              bool ParameterPack,
3188                                              TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTPDecl) const {
3189   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3190   TemplateTypeParmType::Profile(ID, Depth, Index, ParameterPack, TTPDecl);
3191   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3192   TemplateTypeParmType *TypeParm
3193     = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3194 
3195   if (TypeParm)
3196     return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3197 
3198   if (TTPDecl) {
3199     QualType Canon = getTemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3200     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TemplateTypeParmType(TTPDecl, Canon);
3201 
3202     TemplateTypeParmType *TypeCheck
3203       = TemplateTypeParmTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3204     assert(!TypeCheck && "Template type parameter canonical type broken");
3205     (void)TypeCheck;
3206   } else
3207     TypeParm = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3208       TemplateTypeParmType(Depth, Index, ParameterPack);
3209 
3210   Types.push_back(TypeParm);
3211   TemplateTypeParmTypes.InsertNode(TypeParm, InsertPos);
3212 
3213   return QualType(TypeParm, 0);
3214 }
3215 
3216 TypeSourceInfo *
3217 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationTypeInfo(TemplateName Name,
3218                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
3219                                         const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3220                                               QualType Underlying) const {
3221   assert(!Name.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3222          "No dependent template names here!");
3223   QualType TST = getTemplateSpecializationType(Name, Args, Underlying);
3224 
3225   TypeSourceInfo *DI = CreateTypeSourceInfo(TST);
3226   TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc TL =
3227       DI->getTypeLoc().castAs<TemplateSpecializationTypeLoc>();
3228   TL.setTemplateKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
3229   TL.setTemplateNameLoc(NameLoc);
3230   TL.setLAngleLoc(Args.getLAngleLoc());
3231   TL.setRAngleLoc(Args.getRAngleLoc());
3232   for (unsigned i = 0, e = TL.getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i)
3233     TL.setArgLocInfo(i, Args[i].getLocInfo());
3234   return DI;
3235 }
3236 
3237 QualType
3238 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3239                                           const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args,
3240                                           QualType Underlying) const {
3241   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3242          "No dependent template names here!");
3243 
3244   unsigned NumArgs = Args.size();
3245 
3246   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> ArgVec;
3247   ArgVec.reserve(NumArgs);
3248   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; ++i)
3249     ArgVec.push_back(Args[i].getArgument());
3250 
3251   return getTemplateSpecializationType(Template, ArgVec.data(), NumArgs,
3252                                        Underlying);
3253 }
3254 
3255 #ifndef NDEBUG
3256 static bool hasAnyPackExpansions(const TemplateArgument *Args,
3257                                  unsigned NumArgs) {
3258   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3259     if (Args[I].isPackExpansion())
3260       return true;
3261 
3262   return true;
3263 }
3264 #endif
3265 
3266 QualType
3267 ASTContext::getTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3268                                           const TemplateArgument *Args,
3269                                           unsigned NumArgs,
3270                                           QualType Underlying) const {
3271   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3272          "No dependent template names here!");
3273   // Look through qualified template names.
3274   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3275     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3276 
3277   bool IsTypeAlias =
3278     Template.getAsTemplateDecl() &&
3279     isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(Template.getAsTemplateDecl());
3280   QualType CanonType;
3281   if (!Underlying.isNull())
3282     CanonType = getCanonicalType(Underlying);
3283   else {
3284     // We can get here with an alias template when the specialization contains
3285     // a pack expansion that does not match up with a parameter pack.
3286     assert((!IsTypeAlias || hasAnyPackExpansions(Args, NumArgs)) &&
3287            "Caller must compute aliased type");
3288     IsTypeAlias = false;
3289     CanonType = getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args,
3290                                                        NumArgs);
3291   }
3292 
3293   // Allocate the (non-canonical) template specialization type, but don't
3294   // try to unique it: these types typically have location information that
3295   // we don't unique and don't want to lose.
3296   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3297                        sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs +
3298                        (IsTypeAlias? sizeof(QualType) : 0),
3299                        TypeAlignment);
3300   TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3301     = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(Template, Args, NumArgs, CanonType,
3302                                          IsTypeAlias ? Underlying : QualType());
3303 
3304   Types.push_back(Spec);
3305   return QualType(Spec, 0);
3306 }
3307 
3308 QualType
3309 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateSpecializationType(TemplateName Template,
3310                                                    const TemplateArgument *Args,
3311                                                    unsigned NumArgs) const {
3312   assert(!Template.getAsDependentTemplateName() &&
3313          "No dependent template names here!");
3314 
3315   // Look through qualified template names.
3316   if (QualifiedTemplateName *QTN = Template.getAsQualifiedTemplateName())
3317     Template = TemplateName(QTN->getTemplateDecl());
3318 
3319   // Build the canonical template specialization type.
3320   TemplateName CanonTemplate = getCanonicalTemplateName(Template);
3321   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 4> CanonArgs;
3322   CanonArgs.reserve(NumArgs);
3323   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I)
3324     CanonArgs.push_back(getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]));
3325 
3326   // Determine whether this canonical template specialization type already
3327   // exists.
3328   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3329   TemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, CanonTemplate,
3330                                       CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs, *this);
3331 
3332   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3333   TemplateSpecializationType *Spec
3334     = TemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3335 
3336   if (!Spec) {
3337     // Allocate a new canonical template specialization type.
3338     void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(TemplateSpecializationType) +
3339                           sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3340                          TypeAlignment);
3341     Spec = new (Mem) TemplateSpecializationType(CanonTemplate,
3342                                                 CanonArgs.data(), NumArgs,
3343                                                 QualType(), QualType());
3344     Types.push_back(Spec);
3345     TemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(Spec, InsertPos);
3346   }
3347 
3348   assert(Spec->isDependentType() &&
3349          "Non-dependent template-id type must have a canonical type");
3350   return QualType(Spec, 0);
3351 }
3352 
3353 QualType
3354 ASTContext::getElaboratedType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3355                               NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3356                               QualType NamedType) const {
3357   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3358   ElaboratedType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, NamedType);
3359 
3360   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3361   ElaboratedType *T = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3362   if (T)
3363     return QualType(T, 0);
3364 
3365   QualType Canon = NamedType;
3366   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3367     Canon = getCanonicalType(NamedType);
3368     ElaboratedType *CheckT = ElaboratedTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3369     assert(!CheckT && "Elaborated canonical type broken");
3370     (void)CheckT;
3371   }
3372 
3373   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ElaboratedType(Keyword, NNS, NamedType, Canon);
3374   Types.push_back(T);
3375   ElaboratedTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3376   return QualType(T, 0);
3377 }
3378 
3379 QualType
3380 ASTContext::getParenType(QualType InnerType) const {
3381   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3382   ParenType::Profile(ID, InnerType);
3383 
3384   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3385   ParenType *T = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3386   if (T)
3387     return QualType(T, 0);
3388 
3389   QualType Canon = InnerType;
3390   if (!Canon.isCanonical()) {
3391     Canon = getCanonicalType(InnerType);
3392     ParenType *CheckT = ParenTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3393     assert(!CheckT && "Paren canonical type broken");
3394     (void)CheckT;
3395   }
3396 
3397   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) ParenType(InnerType, Canon);
3398   Types.push_back(T);
3399   ParenTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3400   return QualType(T, 0);
3401 }
3402 
3403 QualType ASTContext::getDependentNameType(ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3404                                           NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3405                                           const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3406                                           QualType Canon) const {
3407   if (Canon.isNull()) {
3408     NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3409     ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3410     if (Keyword == ETK_None)
3411       CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3412 
3413     if (CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword)
3414       Canon = getDependentNameType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS, Name);
3415   }
3416 
3417   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3418   DependentNameType::Profile(ID, Keyword, NNS, Name);
3419 
3420   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3421   DependentNameType *T
3422     = DependentNameTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3423   if (T)
3424     return QualType(T, 0);
3425 
3426   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentNameType(Keyword, NNS, Name, Canon);
3427   Types.push_back(T);
3428   DependentNameTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3429   return QualType(T, 0);
3430 }
3431 
3432 QualType
3433 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3434                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3435                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3436                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3437                                  const TemplateArgumentListInfo &Args) const {
3438   // TODO: avoid this copy
3439   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> ArgCopy;
3440   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Args.size(); I != E; ++I)
3441     ArgCopy.push_back(Args[I].getArgument());
3442   return getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS, Name,
3443                                                 ArgCopy.size(),
3444                                                 ArgCopy.data());
3445 }
3446 
3447 QualType
3448 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(
3449                                  ElaboratedTypeKeyword Keyword,
3450                                  NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
3451                                  const IdentifierInfo *Name,
3452                                  unsigned NumArgs,
3453                                  const TemplateArgument *Args) const {
3454   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
3455          "nested-name-specifier must be dependent");
3456 
3457   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3458   DependentTemplateSpecializationType::Profile(ID, *this, Keyword, NNS,
3459                                                Name, NumArgs, Args);
3460 
3461   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3462   DependentTemplateSpecializationType *T
3463     = DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3464   if (T)
3465     return QualType(T, 0);
3466 
3467   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
3468 
3469   ElaboratedTypeKeyword CanonKeyword = Keyword;
3470   if (Keyword == ETK_None) CanonKeyword = ETK_Typename;
3471 
3472   bool AnyNonCanonArgs = false;
3473   SmallVector<TemplateArgument, 16> CanonArgs(NumArgs);
3474   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumArgs; ++I) {
3475     CanonArgs[I] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(Args[I]);
3476     if (!CanonArgs[I].structurallyEquals(Args[I]))
3477       AnyNonCanonArgs = true;
3478   }
3479 
3480   QualType Canon;
3481   if (AnyNonCanonArgs || CanonNNS != NNS || CanonKeyword != Keyword) {
3482     Canon = getDependentTemplateSpecializationType(CanonKeyword, CanonNNS,
3483                                                    Name, NumArgs,
3484                                                    CanonArgs.data());
3485 
3486     // Find the insert position again.
3487     DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3488   }
3489 
3490   void *Mem = Allocate((sizeof(DependentTemplateSpecializationType) +
3491                         sizeof(TemplateArgument) * NumArgs),
3492                        TypeAlignment);
3493   T = new (Mem) DependentTemplateSpecializationType(Keyword, NNS,
3494                                                     Name, NumArgs, Args, Canon);
3495   Types.push_back(T);
3496   DependentTemplateSpecializationTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3497   return QualType(T, 0);
3498 }
3499 
3500 QualType ASTContext::getPackExpansionType(QualType Pattern,
3501                                           Optional<unsigned> NumExpansions) {
3502   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3503   PackExpansionType::Profile(ID, Pattern, NumExpansions);
3504 
3505   assert(Pattern->containsUnexpandedParameterPack() &&
3506          "Pack expansions must expand one or more parameter packs");
3507   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3508   PackExpansionType *T
3509     = PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3510   if (T)
3511     return QualType(T, 0);
3512 
3513   QualType Canon;
3514   if (!Pattern.isCanonical()) {
3515     Canon = getCanonicalType(Pattern);
3516     // The canonical type might not contain an unexpanded parameter pack, if it
3517     // contains an alias template specialization which ignores one of its
3518     // parameters.
3519     if (Canon->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) {
3520       Canon = getPackExpansionType(Canon, NumExpansions);
3521 
3522       // Find the insert position again, in case we inserted an element into
3523       // PackExpansionTypes and invalidated our insert position.
3524       PackExpansionTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3525     }
3526   }
3527 
3528   T = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3529       PackExpansionType(Pattern, Canon, NumExpansions);
3530   Types.push_back(T);
3531   PackExpansionTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3532   return QualType(T, 0);
3533 }
3534 
3535 /// CmpProtocolNames - Comparison predicate for sorting protocols
3536 /// alphabetically.
3537 static int CmpProtocolNames(ObjCProtocolDecl *const *LHS,
3538                             ObjCProtocolDecl *const *RHS) {
3539   return DeclarationName::compare((*LHS)->getDeclName(), (*RHS)->getDeclName());
3540 }
3541 
3542 static bool areSortedAndUniqued(ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3543                                 unsigned NumProtocols) {
3544   if (NumProtocols == 0) return true;
3545 
3546   if (Protocols[0]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[0])
3547     return false;
3548 
3549   for (unsigned i = 1; i != NumProtocols; ++i)
3550     if (CmpProtocolNames(&Protocols[i - 1], &Protocols[i]) >= 0 ||
3551         Protocols[i]->getCanonicalDecl() != Protocols[i])
3552       return false;
3553   return true;
3554 }
3555 
3556 static void SortAndUniqueProtocols(ObjCProtocolDecl **Protocols,
3557                                    unsigned &NumProtocols) {
3558   ObjCProtocolDecl **ProtocolsEnd = Protocols+NumProtocols;
3559 
3560   // Sort protocols, keyed by name.
3561   llvm::array_pod_sort(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd, CmpProtocolNames);
3562 
3563   // Canonicalize.
3564   for (unsigned I = 0, N = NumProtocols; I != N; ++I)
3565     Protocols[I] = Protocols[I]->getCanonicalDecl();
3566 
3567   // Remove duplicates.
3568   ProtocolsEnd = std::unique(Protocols, ProtocolsEnd);
3569   NumProtocols = ProtocolsEnd-Protocols;
3570 }
3571 
3572 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectType(QualType BaseType,
3573                                        ObjCProtocolDecl * const *Protocols,
3574                                        unsigned NumProtocols) const {
3575   // If the base type is an interface and there aren't any protocols
3576   // to add, then the interface type will do just fine.
3577   if (!NumProtocols && isa<ObjCInterfaceType>(BaseType))
3578     return BaseType;
3579 
3580   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3581   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3582   ObjCObjectTypeImpl::Profile(ID, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3583   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3584   if (ObjCObjectType *QT = ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3585     return QualType(QT, 0);
3586 
3587   // Build the canonical type, which has the canonical base type and
3588   // a sorted-and-uniqued list of protocols.
3589   QualType Canonical;
3590   bool ProtocolsSorted = areSortedAndUniqued(Protocols, NumProtocols);
3591   if (!ProtocolsSorted || !BaseType.isCanonical()) {
3592     if (!ProtocolsSorted) {
3593       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl*, 8> Sorted(Protocols,
3594                                                      Protocols + NumProtocols);
3595       unsigned UniqueCount = NumProtocols;
3596 
3597       SortAndUniqueProtocols(&Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
3598       Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3599                                     &Sorted[0], UniqueCount);
3600     } else {
3601       Canonical = getObjCObjectType(getCanonicalType(BaseType),
3602                                     Protocols, NumProtocols);
3603     }
3604 
3605     // Regenerate InsertPos.
3606     ObjCObjectTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3607   }
3608 
3609   unsigned Size = sizeof(ObjCObjectTypeImpl);
3610   Size += NumProtocols * sizeof(ObjCProtocolDecl *);
3611   void *Mem = Allocate(Size, TypeAlignment);
3612   ObjCObjectTypeImpl *T =
3613     new (Mem) ObjCObjectTypeImpl(Canonical, BaseType, Protocols, NumProtocols);
3614 
3615   Types.push_back(T);
3616   ObjCObjectTypes.InsertNode(T, InsertPos);
3617   return QualType(T, 0);
3618 }
3619 
3620 /// ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols - Checks that protocols in IC's
3621 /// protocol list adopt all protocols in QT's qualified-id protocol
3622 /// list.
3623 bool ASTContext::ObjCObjectAdoptsQTypeProtocols(QualType QT,
3624                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IC) {
3625   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3626     return false;
3627 
3628   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3629     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3630     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3631       if (!IC->ClassImplementsProtocol(Proto, false))
3632         return false;
3633     }
3634     return true;
3635   }
3636   return false;
3637 }
3638 
3639 /// QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols - Checks that protocols in
3640 /// QT's qualified-id protocol list adopt all protocols in IDecl's list
3641 /// of protocols.
3642 bool ASTContext::QIdProtocolsAdoptObjCObjectProtocols(QualType QT,
3643                                                 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl) {
3644   if (!QT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
3645     return false;
3646   const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = QT->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3647   if (!OPT)
3648     return false;
3649   if (!IDecl->hasDefinition())
3650     return false;
3651   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocols;
3652   CollectInheritedProtocols(IDecl, InheritedProtocols);
3653   if (InheritedProtocols.empty())
3654     return false;
3655   // Check that if every protocol in list of id<plist> conforms to a protcol
3656   // of IDecl's, then bridge casting is ok.
3657   bool Conforms = false;
3658   for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3659     Conforms = false;
3660     for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3661       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(Proto, PI)) {
3662         Conforms = true;
3663         break;
3664       }
3665     }
3666     if (!Conforms)
3667       break;
3668   }
3669   if (Conforms)
3670     return true;
3671 
3672   for (auto *PI : InheritedProtocols) {
3673     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
3674     bool Adopts = false;
3675     for (auto *Proto : OPT->quals()) {
3676       // return 'true' if 'PI' is in the inheritance hierarchy of Proto
3677       if ((Adopts = ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(PI, Proto)))
3678         break;
3679     }
3680     if (!Adopts)
3681       return false;
3682   }
3683   return true;
3684 }
3685 
3686 /// getObjCObjectPointerType - Return a ObjCObjectPointerType type for
3687 /// the given object type.
3688 QualType ASTContext::getObjCObjectPointerType(QualType ObjectT) const {
3689   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3690   ObjCObjectPointerType::Profile(ID, ObjectT);
3691 
3692   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3693   if (ObjCObjectPointerType *QT =
3694               ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3695     return QualType(QT, 0);
3696 
3697   // Find the canonical object type.
3698   QualType Canonical;
3699   if (!ObjectT.isCanonical()) {
3700     Canonical = getObjCObjectPointerType(getCanonicalType(ObjectT));
3701 
3702     // Regenerate InsertPos.
3703     ObjCObjectPointerTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3704   }
3705 
3706   // No match.
3707   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCObjectPointerType), TypeAlignment);
3708   ObjCObjectPointerType *QType =
3709     new (Mem) ObjCObjectPointerType(Canonical, ObjectT);
3710 
3711   Types.push_back(QType);
3712   ObjCObjectPointerTypes.InsertNode(QType, InsertPos);
3713   return QualType(QType, 0);
3714 }
3715 
3716 /// getObjCInterfaceType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3717 /// specified ObjC interface decl. The list of protocols is optional.
3718 QualType ASTContext::getObjCInterfaceType(const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl,
3719                                           ObjCInterfaceDecl *PrevDecl) const {
3720   if (Decl->TypeForDecl)
3721     return QualType(Decl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3722 
3723   if (PrevDecl) {
3724     assert(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl && "previous decl has no TypeForDecl");
3725     Decl->TypeForDecl = PrevDecl->TypeForDecl;
3726     return QualType(PrevDecl->TypeForDecl, 0);
3727   }
3728 
3729   // Prefer the definition, if there is one.
3730   if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = Decl->getDefinition())
3731     Decl = Def;
3732 
3733   void *Mem = Allocate(sizeof(ObjCInterfaceType), TypeAlignment);
3734   ObjCInterfaceType *T = new (Mem) ObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
3735   Decl->TypeForDecl = T;
3736   Types.push_back(T);
3737   return QualType(T, 0);
3738 }
3739 
3740 /// getTypeOfExprType - Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we can't unique
3741 /// TypeOfExprType AST's (since expression's are never shared). For example,
3742 /// multiple declarations that refer to "typeof(x)" all contain different
3743 /// DeclRefExpr's. This doesn't effect the type checker, since it operates
3744 /// on canonical type's (which are always unique).
3745 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfExprType(Expr *tofExpr) const {
3746   TypeOfExprType *toe;
3747   if (tofExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
3748     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3749     DependentTypeOfExprType::Profile(ID, *this, tofExpr);
3750 
3751     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3752     DependentTypeOfExprType *Canon
3753       = DependentTypeOfExprTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3754     if (Canon) {
3755       // We already have a "canonical" version of an identical, dependent
3756       // typeof(expr) type. Use that as our canonical type.
3757       toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr,
3758                                           QualType((TypeOfExprType*)Canon, 0));
3759     } else {
3760       // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3761       Canon
3762         = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentTypeOfExprType(*this, tofExpr);
3763       DependentTypeOfExprTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3764       toe = Canon;
3765     }
3766   } else {
3767     QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofExpr->getType());
3768     toe = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfExprType(tofExpr, Canonical);
3769   }
3770   Types.push_back(toe);
3771   return QualType(toe, 0);
3772 }
3773 
3774 /// getTypeOfType -  Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique
3775 /// TypeOfType nodes. The only motivation to unique these nodes would be
3776 /// memory savings. Since typeof(t) is fairly uncommon, space shouldn't be
3777 /// an issue. This doesn't affect the type checker, since it operates
3778 /// on canonical types (which are always unique).
3779 QualType ASTContext::getTypeOfType(QualType tofType) const {
3780   QualType Canonical = getCanonicalType(tofType);
3781   TypeOfType *tot = new (*this, TypeAlignment) TypeOfType(tofType, Canonical);
3782   Types.push_back(tot);
3783   return QualType(tot, 0);
3784 }
3785 
3786 
3787 /// \brief Unlike many "get<Type>" functions, we don't unique DecltypeType
3788 /// nodes. This would never be helpful, since each such type has its own
3789 /// expression, and would not give a significant memory saving, since there
3790 /// is an Expr tree under each such type.
3791 QualType ASTContext::getDecltypeType(Expr *e, QualType UnderlyingType) const {
3792   DecltypeType *dt;
3793 
3794   // C++11 [temp.type]p2:
3795   //   If an expression e involves a template parameter, decltype(e) denotes a
3796   //   unique dependent type. Two such decltype-specifiers refer to the same
3797   //   type only if their expressions are equivalent (14.5.6.1).
3798   if (e->isInstantiationDependent()) {
3799     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3800     DependentDecltypeType::Profile(ID, *this, e);
3801 
3802     void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3803     DependentDecltypeType *Canon
3804       = DependentDecltypeTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3805     if (!Canon) {
3806       // Build a new, canonical typeof(expr) type.
3807       Canon = new (*this, TypeAlignment) DependentDecltypeType(*this, e);
3808       DependentDecltypeTypes.InsertNode(Canon, InsertPos);
3809     }
3810     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3811         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, QualType((DecltypeType *)Canon, 0));
3812   } else {
3813     dt = new (*this, TypeAlignment)
3814         DecltypeType(e, UnderlyingType, getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3815   }
3816   Types.push_back(dt);
3817   return QualType(dt, 0);
3818 }
3819 
3820 /// getUnaryTransformationType - We don't unique these, since the memory
3821 /// savings are minimal and these are rare.
3822 QualType ASTContext::getUnaryTransformType(QualType BaseType,
3823                                            QualType UnderlyingType,
3824                                            UnaryTransformType::UTTKind Kind)
3825     const {
3826   UnaryTransformType *Ty =
3827     new (*this, TypeAlignment) UnaryTransformType (BaseType, UnderlyingType,
3828                                                    Kind,
3829                                  UnderlyingType->isDependentType() ?
3830                                  QualType() : getCanonicalType(UnderlyingType));
3831   Types.push_back(Ty);
3832   return QualType(Ty, 0);
3833 }
3834 
3835 /// getAutoType - Return the uniqued reference to the 'auto' type which has been
3836 /// deduced to the given type, or to the canonical undeduced 'auto' type, or the
3837 /// canonical deduced-but-dependent 'auto' type.
3838 QualType ASTContext::getAutoType(QualType DeducedType, bool IsDecltypeAuto,
3839                                  bool IsDependent) const {
3840   if (DeducedType.isNull() && !IsDecltypeAuto && !IsDependent)
3841     return getAutoDeductType();
3842 
3843   // Look in the folding set for an existing type.
3844   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3845   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3846   AutoType::Profile(ID, DeducedType, IsDecltypeAuto, IsDependent);
3847   if (AutoType *AT = AutoTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3848     return QualType(AT, 0);
3849 
3850   AutoType *AT = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(DeducedType,
3851                                                      IsDecltypeAuto,
3852                                                      IsDependent);
3853   Types.push_back(AT);
3854   if (InsertPos)
3855     AutoTypes.InsertNode(AT, InsertPos);
3856   return QualType(AT, 0);
3857 }
3858 
3859 /// getAtomicType - Return the uniqued reference to the atomic type for
3860 /// the given value type.
3861 QualType ASTContext::getAtomicType(QualType T) const {
3862   // Unique pointers, to guarantee there is only one pointer of a particular
3863   // structure.
3864   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
3865   AtomicType::Profile(ID, T);
3866 
3867   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
3868   if (AtomicType *AT = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos))
3869     return QualType(AT, 0);
3870 
3871   // If the atomic value type isn't canonical, this won't be a canonical type
3872   // either, so fill in the canonical type field.
3873   QualType Canonical;
3874   if (!T.isCanonical()) {
3875     Canonical = getAtomicType(getCanonicalType(T));
3876 
3877     // Get the new insert position for the node we care about.
3878     AtomicType *NewIP = AtomicTypes.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
3879     assert(!NewIP && "Shouldn't be in the map!"); (void)NewIP;
3880   }
3881   AtomicType *New = new (*this, TypeAlignment) AtomicType(T, Canonical);
3882   Types.push_back(New);
3883   AtomicTypes.InsertNode(New, InsertPos);
3884   return QualType(New, 0);
3885 }
3886 
3887 /// getAutoDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto'.
3888 QualType ASTContext::getAutoDeductType() const {
3889   if (AutoDeductTy.isNull())
3890     AutoDeductTy = QualType(
3891       new (*this, TypeAlignment) AutoType(QualType(), /*decltype(auto)*/false,
3892                                           /*dependent*/false),
3893       0);
3894   return AutoDeductTy;
3895 }
3896 
3897 /// getAutoRRefDeductType - Get type pattern for deducing against 'auto &&'.
3898 QualType ASTContext::getAutoRRefDeductType() const {
3899   if (AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull())
3900     AutoRRefDeductTy = getRValueReferenceType(getAutoDeductType());
3901   assert(!AutoRRefDeductTy.isNull() && "can't build 'auto &&' pattern");
3902   return AutoRRefDeductTy;
3903 }
3904 
3905 /// getTagDeclType - Return the unique reference to the type for the
3906 /// specified TagDecl (struct/union/class/enum) decl.
3907 QualType ASTContext::getTagDeclType(const TagDecl *Decl) const {
3908   assert (Decl);
3909   // FIXME: What is the design on getTagDeclType when it requires casting
3910   // away const?  mutable?
3911   return getTypeDeclType(const_cast<TagDecl*>(Decl));
3912 }
3913 
3914 /// getSizeType - Return the unique type for "size_t" (C99 7.17), the result
3915 /// of the sizeof operator (C99 6.5.3.4p4). The value is target dependent and
3916 /// needs to agree with the definition in <stddef.h>.
3917 CanQualType ASTContext::getSizeType() const {
3918   return getFromTargetType(Target->getSizeType());
3919 }
3920 
3921 /// getIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "intmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3922 CanQualType ASTContext::getIntMaxType() const {
3923   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntMaxType());
3924 }
3925 
3926 /// getUIntMaxType - Return the unique type for "uintmax_t" (C99 7.18.1.5).
3927 CanQualType ASTContext::getUIntMaxType() const {
3928   return getFromTargetType(Target->getUIntMaxType());
3929 }
3930 
3931 /// getSignedWCharType - Return the type of "signed wchar_t".
3932 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3933 QualType ASTContext::getSignedWCharType() const {
3934   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3935   return WCharTy;
3936 }
3937 
3938 /// getUnsignedWCharType - Return the type of "unsigned wchar_t".
3939 /// Used when in C++, as a GCC extension.
3940 QualType ASTContext::getUnsignedWCharType() const {
3941   // FIXME: derive from "Target" ?
3942   return UnsignedIntTy;
3943 }
3944 
3945 QualType ASTContext::getIntPtrType() const {
3946   return getFromTargetType(Target->getIntPtrType());
3947 }
3948 
3949 QualType ASTContext::getUIntPtrType() const {
3950   return getCorrespondingUnsignedType(getIntPtrType());
3951 }
3952 
3953 /// getPointerDiffType - Return the unique type for "ptrdiff_t" (C99 7.17)
3954 /// defined in <stddef.h>. Pointer - pointer requires this (C99 6.5.6p9).
3955 QualType ASTContext::getPointerDiffType() const {
3956   return getFromTargetType(Target->getPtrDiffType(0));
3957 }
3958 
3959 /// \brief Return the unique type for "pid_t" defined in
3960 /// <sys/types.h>. We need this to compute the correct type for vfork().
3961 QualType ASTContext::getProcessIDType() const {
3962   return getFromTargetType(Target->getProcessIDType());
3963 }
3964 
3965 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3966 //                              Type Operators
3967 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
3968 
3969 CanQualType ASTContext::getCanonicalParamType(QualType T) const {
3970   // Push qualifiers into arrays, and then discard any remaining
3971   // qualifiers.
3972   T = getCanonicalType(T);
3973   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
3974   const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr();
3975   QualType Result;
3976   if (isa<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
3977     Result = getArrayDecayedType(QualType(Ty,0));
3978   } else if (isa<FunctionType>(Ty)) {
3979     Result = getPointerType(QualType(Ty, 0));
3980   } else {
3981     Result = QualType(Ty, 0);
3982   }
3983 
3984   return CanQualType::CreateUnsafe(Result);
3985 }
3986 
3987 QualType ASTContext::getUnqualifiedArrayType(QualType type,
3988                                              Qualifiers &quals) {
3989   SplitQualType splitType = type.getSplitUnqualifiedType();
3990 
3991   // FIXME: getSplitUnqualifiedType() actually walks all the way to
3992   // the unqualified desugared type and then drops it on the floor.
3993   // We then have to strip that sugar back off with
3994   // getUnqualifiedDesugaredType(), which is silly.
3995   const ArrayType *AT =
3996     dyn_cast<ArrayType>(splitType.Ty->getUnqualifiedDesugaredType());
3997 
3998   // If we don't have an array, just use the results in splitType.
3999   if (!AT) {
4000     quals = splitType.Quals;
4001     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4002   }
4003 
4004   // Otherwise, recurse on the array's element type.
4005   QualType elementType = AT->getElementType();
4006   QualType unqualElementType = getUnqualifiedArrayType(elementType, quals);
4007 
4008   // If that didn't change the element type, AT has no qualifiers, so we
4009   // can just use the results in splitType.
4010   if (elementType == unqualElementType) {
4011     assert(quals.empty()); // from the recursive call
4012     quals = splitType.Quals;
4013     return QualType(splitType.Ty, 0);
4014   }
4015 
4016   // Otherwise, add in the qualifiers from the outermost type, then
4017   // build the type back up.
4018   quals.addConsistentQualifiers(splitType.Quals);
4019 
4020   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT)) {
4021     return getConstantArrayType(unqualElementType, CAT->getSize(),
4022                                 CAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4023   }
4024 
4025   if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) {
4026     return getIncompleteArrayType(unqualElementType, IAT->getSizeModifier(), 0);
4027   }
4028 
4029   if (const VariableArrayType *VAT = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(AT)) {
4030     return getVariableArrayType(unqualElementType,
4031                                 VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4032                                 VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4033                                 VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4034                                 VAT->getBracketsRange());
4035   }
4036 
4037   const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT = cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(AT);
4038   return getDependentSizedArrayType(unqualElementType, DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4039                                     DSAT->getSizeModifier(), 0,
4040                                     SourceRange());
4041 }
4042 
4043 /// UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes - If T1 and T2 are pointer types  that
4044 /// may be similar (C++ 4.4), replaces T1 and T2 with the type that
4045 /// they point to and return true. If T1 and T2 aren't pointer types
4046 /// or pointer-to-member types, or if they are not similar at this
4047 /// level, returns false and leaves T1 and T2 unchanged. Top-level
4048 /// qualifiers on T1 and T2 are ignored. This function will typically
4049 /// be called in a loop that successively "unwraps" pointer and
4050 /// pointer-to-member types to compare them at each level.
4051 bool ASTContext::UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(QualType &T1, QualType &T2) {
4052   const PointerType *T1PtrType = T1->getAs<PointerType>(),
4053                     *T2PtrType = T2->getAs<PointerType>();
4054   if (T1PtrType && T2PtrType) {
4055     T1 = T1PtrType->getPointeeType();
4056     T2 = T2PtrType->getPointeeType();
4057     return true;
4058   }
4059 
4060   const MemberPointerType *T1MPType = T1->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
4061                           *T2MPType = T2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4062   if (T1MPType && T2MPType &&
4063       hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(T1MPType->getClass(), 0),
4064                              QualType(T2MPType->getClass(), 0))) {
4065     T1 = T1MPType->getPointeeType();
4066     T2 = T2MPType->getPointeeType();
4067     return true;
4068   }
4069 
4070   if (getLangOpts().ObjC1) {
4071     const ObjCObjectPointerType *T1OPType = T1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
4072                                 *T2OPType = T2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4073     if (T1OPType && T2OPType) {
4074       T1 = T1OPType->getPointeeType();
4075       T2 = T2OPType->getPointeeType();
4076       return true;
4077     }
4078   }
4079 
4080   // FIXME: Block pointers, too?
4081 
4082   return false;
4083 }
4084 
4085 DeclarationNameInfo
4086 ASTContext::getNameForTemplate(TemplateName Name,
4087                                SourceLocation NameLoc) const {
4088   switch (Name.getKind()) {
4089   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4090   case TemplateName::Template:
4091     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4092     return DeclarationNameInfo(Name.getAsTemplateDecl()->getDeclName(),
4093                                NameLoc);
4094 
4095   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate: {
4096     OverloadedTemplateStorage *Storage = Name.getAsOverloadedTemplate();
4097     // DNInfo work in progress: CHECKME: what about DNLoc?
4098     return DeclarationNameInfo((*Storage->begin())->getDeclName(), NameLoc);
4099   }
4100 
4101   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4102     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4103     DeclarationName DName;
4104     if (DTN->isIdentifier()) {
4105       DName = DeclarationNames.getIdentifier(DTN->getIdentifier());
4106       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc);
4107     } else {
4108       DName = DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(DTN->getOperator());
4109       // DNInfo work in progress: FIXME: source locations?
4110       DeclarationNameLoc DNLoc;
4111       DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4112       DNLoc.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = SourceLocation().getRawEncoding();
4113       return DeclarationNameInfo(DName, NameLoc, DNLoc);
4114     }
4115   }
4116 
4117   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4118     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4119       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4120     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameter()->getDeclName(),
4121                                NameLoc);
4122   }
4123 
4124   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4125     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4126       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4127     return DeclarationNameInfo(subst->getParameterPack()->getDeclName(),
4128                                NameLoc);
4129   }
4130   }
4131 
4132   llvm_unreachable("bad template name kind!");
4133 }
4134 
4135 TemplateName ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateName(TemplateName Name) const {
4136   switch (Name.getKind()) {
4137   case TemplateName::QualifiedTemplate:
4138   case TemplateName::Template: {
4139     TemplateDecl *Template = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
4140     if (TemplateTemplateParmDecl *TTP
4141           = dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(Template))
4142       Template = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(TTP);
4143 
4144     // The canonical template name is the canonical template declaration.
4145     return TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(Template->getCanonicalDecl()));
4146   }
4147 
4148   case TemplateName::OverloadedTemplate:
4149     llvm_unreachable("cannot canonicalize overloaded template");
4150 
4151   case TemplateName::DependentTemplate: {
4152     DependentTemplateName *DTN = Name.getAsDependentTemplateName();
4153     assert(DTN && "Non-dependent template names must refer to template decls.");
4154     return DTN->CanonicalTemplateName;
4155   }
4156 
4157   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParm: {
4158     SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
4159       = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParm();
4160     return getCanonicalTemplateName(subst->getReplacement());
4161   }
4162 
4163   case TemplateName::SubstTemplateTemplateParmPack: {
4164     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *subst
4165                                   = Name.getAsSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack();
4166     TemplateTemplateParmDecl *canonParameter
4167       = getCanonicalTemplateTemplateParmDecl(subst->getParameterPack());
4168     TemplateArgument canonArgPack
4169       = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(subst->getArgumentPack());
4170     return getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(canonParameter, canonArgPack);
4171   }
4172   }
4173 
4174   llvm_unreachable("bad template name!");
4175 }
4176 
4177 bool ASTContext::hasSameTemplateName(TemplateName X, TemplateName Y) {
4178   X = getCanonicalTemplateName(X);
4179   Y = getCanonicalTemplateName(Y);
4180   return X.getAsVoidPointer() == Y.getAsVoidPointer();
4181 }
4182 
4183 TemplateArgument
4184 ASTContext::getCanonicalTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg) const {
4185   switch (Arg.getKind()) {
4186     case TemplateArgument::Null:
4187       return Arg;
4188 
4189     case TemplateArgument::Expression:
4190       return Arg;
4191 
4192     case TemplateArgument::Declaration: {
4193       ValueDecl *D = cast<ValueDecl>(Arg.getAsDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
4194       return TemplateArgument(D, Arg.getParamTypeForDecl());
4195     }
4196 
4197     case TemplateArgument::NullPtr:
4198       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getNullPtrType()),
4199                               /*isNullPtr*/true);
4200 
4201     case TemplateArgument::Template:
4202       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(Arg.getAsTemplate()));
4203 
4204     case TemplateArgument::TemplateExpansion:
4205       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalTemplateName(
4206                                          Arg.getAsTemplateOrTemplatePattern()),
4207                               Arg.getNumTemplateExpansions());
4208 
4209     case TemplateArgument::Integral:
4210       return TemplateArgument(Arg, getCanonicalType(Arg.getIntegralType()));
4211 
4212     case TemplateArgument::Type:
4213       return TemplateArgument(getCanonicalType(Arg.getAsType()));
4214 
4215     case TemplateArgument::Pack: {
4216       if (Arg.pack_size() == 0)
4217         return Arg;
4218 
4219       TemplateArgument *CanonArgs
4220         = new (*this) TemplateArgument[Arg.pack_size()];
4221       unsigned Idx = 0;
4222       for (TemplateArgument::pack_iterator A = Arg.pack_begin(),
4223                                         AEnd = Arg.pack_end();
4224            A != AEnd; (void)++A, ++Idx)
4225         CanonArgs[Idx] = getCanonicalTemplateArgument(*A);
4226 
4227       return TemplateArgument(CanonArgs, Arg.pack_size());
4228     }
4229   }
4230 
4231   // Silence GCC warning
4232   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled template argument kind");
4233 }
4234 
4235 NestedNameSpecifier *
4236 ASTContext::getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS) const {
4237   if (!NNS)
4238     return nullptr;
4239 
4240   switch (NNS->getKind()) {
4241   case NestedNameSpecifier::Identifier:
4242     // Canonicalize the prefix but keep the identifier the same.
4243     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this,
4244                          getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS->getPrefix()),
4245                                        NNS->getAsIdentifier());
4246 
4247   case NestedNameSpecifier::Namespace:
4248     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4249     // this namespace and no prefix.
4250     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4251                                  NNS->getAsNamespace()->getOriginalNamespace());
4252 
4253   case NestedNameSpecifier::NamespaceAlias:
4254     // A namespace is canonical; build a nested-name-specifier with
4255     // this namespace and no prefix.
4256     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr,
4257                                     NNS->getAsNamespaceAlias()->getNamespace()
4258                                                       ->getOriginalNamespace());
4259 
4260   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpec:
4261   case NestedNameSpecifier::TypeSpecWithTemplate: {
4262     QualType T = getCanonicalType(QualType(NNS->getAsType(), 0));
4263 
4264     // If we have some kind of dependent-named type (e.g., "typename T::type"),
4265     // break it apart into its prefix and identifier, then reconsititute those
4266     // as the canonical nested-name-specifier. This is required to canonicalize
4267     // a dependent nested-name-specifier involving typedefs of dependent-name
4268     // types, e.g.,
4269     //   typedef typename T::type T1;
4270     //   typedef typename T1::type T2;
4271     if (const DependentNameType *DNT = T->getAs<DependentNameType>())
4272       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, DNT->getQualifier(),
4273                            const_cast<IdentifierInfo *>(DNT->getIdentifier()));
4274 
4275     // Otherwise, just canonicalize the type, and force it to be a TypeSpec.
4276     // FIXME: Why are TypeSpec and TypeSpecWithTemplate distinct in the
4277     // first place?
4278     return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(*this, nullptr, false,
4279                                        const_cast<Type *>(T.getTypePtr()));
4280   }
4281 
4282   case NestedNameSpecifier::Global:
4283   case NestedNameSpecifier::Super:
4284     // The global specifier and __super specifer are canonical and unique.
4285     return NNS;
4286   }
4287 
4288   llvm_unreachable("Invalid NestedNameSpecifier::Kind!");
4289 }
4290 
4291 
4292 const ArrayType *ASTContext::getAsArrayType(QualType T) const {
4293   // Handle the non-qualified case efficiently.
4294   if (!T.hasLocalQualifiers()) {
4295     // Handle the common positive case fast.
4296     if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(T))
4297       return AT;
4298   }
4299 
4300   // Handle the common negative case fast.
4301   if (!isa<ArrayType>(T.getCanonicalType()))
4302     return nullptr;
4303 
4304   // Apply any qualifiers from the array type to the element type.  This
4305   // implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of an array type includes
4306   // any type qualifiers, the element type is so qualified, not the array type."
4307 
4308   // If we get here, we either have type qualifiers on the type, or we have
4309   // sugar such as a typedef in the way.  If we have type qualifiers on the type
4310   // we must propagate them down into the element type.
4311 
4312   SplitQualType split = T.getSplitDesugaredType();
4313   Qualifiers qs = split.Quals;
4314 
4315   // If we have a simple case, just return now.
4316   const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(split.Ty);
4317   if (!ATy || qs.empty())
4318     return ATy;
4319 
4320   // Otherwise, we have an array and we have qualifiers on it.  Push the
4321   // qualifiers into the array element type and return a new array type.
4322   QualType NewEltTy = getQualifiedType(ATy->getElementType(), qs);
4323 
4324   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(ATy))
4325     return cast<ArrayType>(getConstantArrayType(NewEltTy, CAT->getSize(),
4326                                                 CAT->getSizeModifier(),
4327                                            CAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4328   if (const IncompleteArrayType *IAT = dyn_cast<IncompleteArrayType>(ATy))
4329     return cast<ArrayType>(getIncompleteArrayType(NewEltTy,
4330                                                   IAT->getSizeModifier(),
4331                                            IAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers()));
4332 
4333   if (const DependentSizedArrayType *DSAT
4334         = dyn_cast<DependentSizedArrayType>(ATy))
4335     return cast<ArrayType>(
4336                      getDependentSizedArrayType(NewEltTy,
4337                                                 DSAT->getSizeExpr(),
4338                                                 DSAT->getSizeModifier(),
4339                                               DSAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4340                                                 DSAT->getBracketsRange()));
4341 
4342   const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(ATy);
4343   return cast<ArrayType>(getVariableArrayType(NewEltTy,
4344                                               VAT->getSizeExpr(),
4345                                               VAT->getSizeModifier(),
4346                                               VAT->getIndexTypeCVRQualifiers(),
4347                                               VAT->getBracketsRange()));
4348 }
4349 
4350 QualType ASTContext::getAdjustedParameterType(QualType T) const {
4351   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4352     return getDecayedType(T);
4353   return T;
4354 }
4355 
4356 QualType ASTContext::getSignatureParameterType(QualType T) const {
4357   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4358   T = getAdjustedParameterType(T);
4359   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4360 }
4361 
4362 QualType ASTContext::getExceptionObjectType(QualType T) const {
4363   // C++ [except.throw]p3:
4364   //   A throw-expression initializes a temporary object, called the exception
4365   //   object, the type of which is determined by removing any top-level
4366   //   cv-qualifiers from the static type of the operand of throw and adjusting
4367   //   the type from "array of T" or "function returning T" to "pointer to T"
4368   //   or "pointer to function returning T", [...]
4369   T = getVariableArrayDecayedType(T);
4370   if (T->isArrayType() || T->isFunctionType())
4371     T = getDecayedType(T);
4372   return T.getUnqualifiedType();
4373 }
4374 
4375 /// getArrayDecayedType - Return the properly qualified result of decaying the
4376 /// specified array type to a pointer.  This operation is non-trivial when
4377 /// handling typedefs etc.  The canonical type of "T" must be an array type,
4378 /// this returns a pointer to a properly qualified element of the array.
4379 ///
4380 /// See C99 6.7.5.3p7 and C99 6.3.2.1p3.
4381 QualType ASTContext::getArrayDecayedType(QualType Ty) const {
4382   // Get the element type with 'getAsArrayType' so that we don't lose any
4383   // typedefs in the element type of the array.  This also handles propagation
4384   // of type qualifiers from the array type into the element type if present
4385   // (C99 6.7.3p8).
4386   const ArrayType *PrettyArrayType = getAsArrayType(Ty);
4387   assert(PrettyArrayType && "Not an array type!");
4388 
4389   QualType PtrTy = getPointerType(PrettyArrayType->getElementType());
4390 
4391   // int x[restrict 4] ->  int *restrict
4392   return getQualifiedType(PtrTy, PrettyArrayType->getIndexTypeQualifiers());
4393 }
4394 
4395 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(const ArrayType *array) const {
4396   return getBaseElementType(array->getElementType());
4397 }
4398 
4399 QualType ASTContext::getBaseElementType(QualType type) const {
4400   Qualifiers qs;
4401   while (true) {
4402     SplitQualType split = type.getSplitDesugaredType();
4403     const ArrayType *array = split.Ty->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe();
4404     if (!array) break;
4405 
4406     type = array->getElementType();
4407     qs.addConsistentQualifiers(split.Quals);
4408   }
4409 
4410   return getQualifiedType(type, qs);
4411 }
4412 
4413 /// getConstantArrayElementCount - Returns number of constant array elements.
4414 uint64_t
4415 ASTContext::getConstantArrayElementCount(const ConstantArrayType *CA)  const {
4416   uint64_t ElementCount = 1;
4417   do {
4418     ElementCount *= CA->getSize().getZExtValue();
4419     CA = dyn_cast_or_null<ConstantArrayType>(
4420       CA->getElementType()->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe());
4421   } while (CA);
4422   return ElementCount;
4423 }
4424 
4425 /// getFloatingRank - Return a relative rank for floating point types.
4426 /// This routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't a float.
4427 static FloatingRank getFloatingRank(QualType T) {
4428   if (const ComplexType *CT = T->getAs<ComplexType>())
4429     return getFloatingRank(CT->getElementType());
4430 
4431   assert(T->getAs<BuiltinType>() && "getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4432   switch (T->getAs<BuiltinType>()->getKind()) {
4433   default: llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): not a floating type");
4434   case BuiltinType::Half:       return HalfRank;
4435   case BuiltinType::Float:      return FloatRank;
4436   case BuiltinType::Double:     return DoubleRank;
4437   case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return LongDoubleRank;
4438   }
4439 }
4440 
4441 /// getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain - Returns a real floating
4442 /// point or a complex type (based on typeDomain/typeSize).
4443 /// 'typeDomain' is a real floating point or complex type.
4444 /// 'typeSize' is a real floating point or complex type.
4445 QualType ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOfSizeWithinDomain(QualType Size,
4446                                                        QualType Domain) const {
4447   FloatingRank EltRank = getFloatingRank(Size);
4448   if (Domain->isComplexType()) {
4449     switch (EltRank) {
4450     case HalfRank: llvm_unreachable("Complex half is not supported");
4451     case FloatRank:      return FloatComplexTy;
4452     case DoubleRank:     return DoubleComplexTy;
4453     case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleComplexTy;
4454     }
4455   }
4456 
4457   assert(Domain->isRealFloatingType() && "Unknown domain!");
4458   switch (EltRank) {
4459   case HalfRank:       return HalfTy;
4460   case FloatRank:      return FloatTy;
4461   case DoubleRank:     return DoubleTy;
4462   case LongDoubleRank: return LongDoubleTy;
4463   }
4464   llvm_unreachable("getFloatingRank(): illegal value for rank");
4465 }
4466 
4467 /// getFloatingTypeOrder - Compare the rank of the two specified floating
4468 /// point types, ignoring the domain of the type (i.e. 'double' ==
4469 /// '_Complex double').  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4470 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
4471 int ASTContext::getFloatingTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4472   FloatingRank LHSR = getFloatingRank(LHS);
4473   FloatingRank RHSR = getFloatingRank(RHS);
4474 
4475   if (LHSR == RHSR)
4476     return 0;
4477   if (LHSR > RHSR)
4478     return 1;
4479   return -1;
4480 }
4481 
4482 /// getIntegerRank - Return an integer conversion rank (C99 6.3.1.1p1). This
4483 /// routine will assert if passed a built-in type that isn't an integer or enum,
4484 /// or if it is not canonicalized.
4485 unsigned ASTContext::getIntegerRank(const Type *T) const {
4486   assert(T->isCanonicalUnqualified() && "T should be canonicalized");
4487 
4488   switch (cast<BuiltinType>(T)->getKind()) {
4489   default: llvm_unreachable("getIntegerRank(): not a built-in integer");
4490   case BuiltinType::Bool:
4491     return 1 + (getIntWidth(BoolTy) << 3);
4492   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
4493   case BuiltinType::Char_U:
4494   case BuiltinType::SChar:
4495   case BuiltinType::UChar:
4496     return 2 + (getIntWidth(CharTy) << 3);
4497   case BuiltinType::Short:
4498   case BuiltinType::UShort:
4499     return 3 + (getIntWidth(ShortTy) << 3);
4500   case BuiltinType::Int:
4501   case BuiltinType::UInt:
4502     return 4 + (getIntWidth(IntTy) << 3);
4503   case BuiltinType::Long:
4504   case BuiltinType::ULong:
4505     return 5 + (getIntWidth(LongTy) << 3);
4506   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
4507   case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
4508     return 6 + (getIntWidth(LongLongTy) << 3);
4509   case BuiltinType::Int128:
4510   case BuiltinType::UInt128:
4511     return 7 + (getIntWidth(Int128Ty) << 3);
4512   }
4513 }
4514 
4515 /// \brief Whether this is a promotable bitfield reference according
4516 /// to C99 6.3.1.1p2, bullet 2 (and GCC extensions).
4517 ///
4518 /// \returns the type this bit-field will promote to, or NULL if no
4519 /// promotion occurs.
4520 QualType ASTContext::isPromotableBitField(Expr *E) const {
4521   if (E->isTypeDependent() || E->isValueDependent())
4522     return QualType();
4523 
4524   // FIXME: We should not do this unless E->refersToBitField() is true. This
4525   // matters in C where getSourceBitField() will find bit-fields for various
4526   // cases where the source expression is not a bit-field designator.
4527 
4528   FieldDecl *Field = E->getSourceBitField(); // FIXME: conditional bit-fields?
4529   if (!Field)
4530     return QualType();
4531 
4532   QualType FT = Field->getType();
4533 
4534   uint64_t BitWidth = Field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
4535   uint64_t IntSize = getTypeSize(IntTy);
4536   // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
4537   //   A prvalue for an integral bit-field can be converted to a prvalue of type
4538   //   int if int can represent all the values of the bit-field; otherwise, it
4539   //   can be converted to unsigned int if unsigned int can represent all the
4540   //   values of the bit-field. If the bit-field is larger yet, no integral
4541   //   promotion applies to it.
4542   // C11 6.3.1.1/2:
4543   //   [For a bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int:]
4544   //   If an int can represent all values of the original type (as restricted by
4545   //   the width, for a bit-field), the value is converted to an int; otherwise,
4546   //   it is converted to an unsigned int.
4547   //
4548   // FIXME: C does not permit promotion of a 'long : 3' bitfield to int.
4549   //        We perform that promotion here to match GCC and C++.
4550   if (BitWidth < IntSize)
4551     return IntTy;
4552 
4553   if (BitWidth == IntSize)
4554     return FT->isSignedIntegerType() ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4555 
4556   // Types bigger than int are not subject to promotions, and therefore act
4557   // like the base type. GCC has some weird bugs in this area that we
4558   // deliberately do not follow (GCC follows a pre-standard resolution to
4559   // C's DR315 which treats bit-width as being part of the type, and this leaks
4560   // into their semantics in some cases).
4561   return QualType();
4562 }
4563 
4564 /// getPromotedIntegerType - Returns the type that Promotable will
4565 /// promote to: C99 6.3.1.1p2, assuming that Promotable is a promotable
4566 /// integer type.
4567 QualType ASTContext::getPromotedIntegerType(QualType Promotable) const {
4568   assert(!Promotable.isNull());
4569   assert(Promotable->isPromotableIntegerType());
4570   if (const EnumType *ET = Promotable->getAs<EnumType>())
4571     return ET->getDecl()->getPromotionType();
4572 
4573   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Promotable->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4574     // C++ [conv.prom]: A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t
4575     // (3.9.1) can be converted to a prvalue of the first of the following
4576     // types that can represent all the values of its underlying type:
4577     // int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or
4578     // unsigned long long int [...]
4579     // FIXME: Is there some better way to compute this?
4580     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S ||
4581         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_U ||
4582         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char16 ||
4583         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Char32) {
4584       bool FromIsSigned = BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::WChar_S;
4585       uint64_t FromSize = getTypeSize(BT);
4586       QualType PromoteTypes[] = { IntTy, UnsignedIntTy, LongTy, UnsignedLongTy,
4587                                   LongLongTy, UnsignedLongLongTy };
4588       for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < llvm::array_lengthof(PromoteTypes); ++Idx) {
4589         uint64_t ToSize = getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
4590         if (FromSize < ToSize ||
4591             (FromSize == ToSize &&
4592              FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType()))
4593           return PromoteTypes[Idx];
4594       }
4595       llvm_unreachable("char type should fit into long long");
4596     }
4597   }
4598 
4599   // At this point, we should have a signed or unsigned integer type.
4600   if (Promotable->isSignedIntegerType())
4601     return IntTy;
4602   uint64_t PromotableSize = getIntWidth(Promotable);
4603   uint64_t IntSize = getIntWidth(IntTy);
4604   assert(Promotable->isUnsignedIntegerType() && PromotableSize <= IntSize);
4605   return (PromotableSize != IntSize) ? IntTy : UnsignedIntTy;
4606 }
4607 
4608 /// \brief Recurses in pointer/array types until it finds an objc retainable
4609 /// type and returns its ownership.
4610 Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime ASTContext::getInnerObjCOwnership(QualType T) const {
4611   while (!T.isNull()) {
4612     if (T.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_None)
4613       return T.getObjCLifetime();
4614     if (T->isArrayType())
4615       T = getBaseElementType(T);
4616     else if (const PointerType *PT = T->getAs<PointerType>())
4617       T = PT->getPointeeType();
4618     else if (const ReferenceType *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4619       T = RT->getPointeeType();
4620     else
4621       break;
4622   }
4623 
4624   return Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4625 }
4626 
4627 static const Type *getIntegerTypeForEnum(const EnumType *ET) {
4628   // Incomplete enum types are not treated as integer types.
4629   // FIXME: In C++, enum types are never integer types.
4630   if (ET->getDecl()->isComplete() && !ET->getDecl()->isScoped())
4631     return ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType().getTypePtr();
4632   return nullptr;
4633 }
4634 
4635 /// getIntegerTypeOrder - Returns the highest ranked integer type:
4636 /// C99 6.3.1.8p1.  If LHS > RHS, return 1.  If LHS == RHS, return 0. If
4637 /// LHS < RHS, return -1.
4638 int ASTContext::getIntegerTypeOrder(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) const {
4639   const Type *LHSC = getCanonicalType(LHS).getTypePtr();
4640   const Type *RHSC = getCanonicalType(RHS).getTypePtr();
4641 
4642   // Unwrap enums to their underlying type.
4643   if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(LHSC))
4644     LHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4645   if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(RHSC))
4646     RHSC = getIntegerTypeForEnum(ET);
4647 
4648   if (LHSC == RHSC) return 0;
4649 
4650   bool LHSUnsigned = LHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4651   bool RHSUnsigned = RHSC->isUnsignedIntegerType();
4652 
4653   unsigned LHSRank = getIntegerRank(LHSC);
4654   unsigned RHSRank = getIntegerRank(RHSC);
4655 
4656   if (LHSUnsigned == RHSUnsigned) {  // Both signed or both unsigned.
4657     if (LHSRank == RHSRank) return 0;
4658     return LHSRank > RHSRank ? 1 : -1;
4659   }
4660 
4661   // Otherwise, the LHS is signed and the RHS is unsigned or visa versa.
4662   if (LHSUnsigned) {
4663     // If the unsigned [LHS] type is larger, return it.
4664     if (LHSRank >= RHSRank)
4665       return 1;
4666 
4667     // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4668     // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4669     // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4670     return -1;
4671   }
4672 
4673   // If the unsigned [RHS] type is larger, return it.
4674   if (RHSRank >= LHSRank)
4675     return -1;
4676 
4677   // If the signed type can represent all values of the unsigned type, it
4678   // wins.  Because we are dealing with 2's complement and types that are
4679   // powers of two larger than each other, this is always safe.
4680   return 1;
4681 }
4682 
4683 // getCFConstantStringType - Return the type used for constant CFStrings.
4684 QualType ASTContext::getCFConstantStringType() const {
4685   if (!CFConstantStringTypeDecl) {
4686     CFConstantStringTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("NSConstantString");
4687     CFConstantStringTypeDecl->startDefinition();
4688 
4689     QualType FieldTypes[4];
4690 
4691     // const int *isa;
4692     FieldTypes[0] = getPointerType(IntTy.withConst());
4693     // int flags;
4694     FieldTypes[1] = IntTy;
4695     // const char *str;
4696     FieldTypes[2] = getPointerType(CharTy.withConst());
4697     // long length;
4698     FieldTypes[3] = LongTy;
4699 
4700     // Create fields
4701     for (unsigned i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4702       FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*this, CFConstantStringTypeDecl,
4703                                            SourceLocation(),
4704                                            SourceLocation(), nullptr,
4705                                            FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4706                                            /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4707                                            /*Mutable=*/false,
4708                                            ICIS_NoInit);
4709       Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4710       CFConstantStringTypeDecl->addDecl(Field);
4711     }
4712 
4713     CFConstantStringTypeDecl->completeDefinition();
4714   }
4715 
4716   return getTagDeclType(CFConstantStringTypeDecl);
4717 }
4718 
4719 QualType ASTContext::getObjCSuperType() const {
4720   if (ObjCSuperType.isNull()) {
4721     RecordDecl *ObjCSuperTypeDecl = buildImplicitRecord("objc_super");
4722     TUDecl->addDecl(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4723     ObjCSuperType = getTagDeclType(ObjCSuperTypeDecl);
4724   }
4725   return ObjCSuperType;
4726 }
4727 
4728 void ASTContext::setCFConstantStringType(QualType T) {
4729   const RecordType *Rec = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4730   assert(Rec && "Invalid CFConstantStringType");
4731   CFConstantStringTypeDecl = Rec->getDecl();
4732 }
4733 
4734 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorType() const {
4735   if (BlockDescriptorType)
4736     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4737 
4738   RecordDecl *RD;
4739   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4740   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor");
4741   RD->startDefinition();
4742 
4743   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4744     UnsignedLongTy,
4745     UnsignedLongTy,
4746   };
4747 
4748   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4749     "reserved",
4750     "Size"
4751   };
4752 
4753   for (size_t i = 0; i < 2; ++i) {
4754     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4755         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4756         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4757         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4758     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4759     RD->addDecl(Field);
4760   }
4761 
4762   RD->completeDefinition();
4763 
4764   BlockDescriptorType = RD;
4765 
4766   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorType);
4767 }
4768 
4769 QualType ASTContext::getBlockDescriptorExtendedType() const {
4770   if (BlockDescriptorExtendedType)
4771     return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4772 
4773   RecordDecl *RD;
4774   // FIXME: Needs the FlagAppleBlock bit.
4775   RD = buildImplicitRecord("__block_descriptor_withcopydispose");
4776   RD->startDefinition();
4777 
4778   QualType FieldTypes[] = {
4779     UnsignedLongTy,
4780     UnsignedLongTy,
4781     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy),
4782     getPointerType(VoidPtrTy)
4783   };
4784 
4785   static const char *const FieldNames[] = {
4786     "reserved",
4787     "Size",
4788     "CopyFuncPtr",
4789     "DestroyFuncPtr"
4790   };
4791 
4792   for (size_t i = 0; i < 4; ++i) {
4793     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(
4794         *this, RD, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(),
4795         &Idents.get(FieldNames[i]), FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
4796         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
4797         /*Mutable=*/false, ICIS_NoInit);
4798     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
4799     RD->addDecl(Field);
4800   }
4801 
4802   RD->completeDefinition();
4803 
4804   BlockDescriptorExtendedType = RD;
4805   return getTagDeclType(BlockDescriptorExtendedType);
4806 }
4807 
4808 /// BlockRequiresCopying - Returns true if byref variable "D" of type "Ty"
4809 /// requires copy/dispose. Note that this must match the logic
4810 /// in buildByrefHelpers.
4811 bool ASTContext::BlockRequiresCopying(QualType Ty,
4812                                       const VarDecl *D) {
4813   if (const CXXRecordDecl *record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
4814     const Expr *copyExpr = getBlockVarCopyInits(D);
4815     if (!copyExpr && record->hasTrivialDestructor()) return false;
4816 
4817     return true;
4818   }
4819 
4820   if (!Ty->isObjCRetainableType()) return false;
4821 
4822   Qualifiers qs = Ty.getQualifiers();
4823 
4824   // If we have lifetime, that dominates.
4825   if (Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = qs.getObjCLifetime()) {
4826     assert(getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4827 
4828     switch (lifetime) {
4829       case Qualifiers::OCL_None: llvm_unreachable("impossible");
4830 
4831       // These are just bits as far as the runtime is concerned.
4832       case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
4833       case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
4834         return false;
4835 
4836       // Tell the runtime that this is ARC __weak, called by the
4837       // byref routines.
4838       case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
4839       // ARC __strong __block variables need to be retained.
4840       case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
4841         return true;
4842     }
4843     llvm_unreachable("fell out of lifetime switch!");
4844   }
4845   return (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || isObjCNSObjectType(Ty) ||
4846           Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType());
4847 }
4848 
4849 bool ASTContext::getByrefLifetime(QualType Ty,
4850                               Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime &LifeTime,
4851                               bool &HasByrefExtendedLayout) const {
4852 
4853   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1 ||
4854       getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
4855     return false;
4856 
4857   HasByrefExtendedLayout = false;
4858   if (Ty->isRecordType()) {
4859     HasByrefExtendedLayout = true;
4860     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4861   }
4862   else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount)
4863     LifeTime = Ty.getObjCLifetime();
4864   // MRR.
4865   else if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
4866     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
4867   else
4868     LifeTime = Qualifiers::OCL_None;
4869   return true;
4870 }
4871 
4872 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCInstanceTypeDecl() {
4873   if (!ObjCInstanceTypeDecl)
4874     ObjCInstanceTypeDecl =
4875         buildImplicitTypedef(getObjCIdType(), "instancetype");
4876   return ObjCInstanceTypeDecl;
4877 }
4878 
4879 // This returns true if a type has been typedefed to BOOL:
4880 // typedef <type> BOOL;
4881 static bool isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(QualType T) {
4882   if (const TypedefType *TT = dyn_cast<TypedefType>(T))
4883     if (IdentifierInfo *II = TT->getDecl()->getIdentifier())
4884       return II->isStr("BOOL");
4885 
4886   return false;
4887 }
4888 
4889 /// getObjCEncodingTypeSize returns size of type for objective-c encoding
4890 /// purpose.
4891 CharUnits ASTContext::getObjCEncodingTypeSize(QualType type) const {
4892   if (!type->isIncompleteArrayType() && type->isIncompleteType())
4893     return CharUnits::Zero();
4894 
4895   CharUnits sz = getTypeSizeInChars(type);
4896 
4897   // Make all integer and enum types at least as large as an int
4898   if (sz.isPositive() && type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
4899     sz = std::max(sz, getTypeSizeInChars(IntTy));
4900   // Treat arrays as pointers, since that's how they're passed in.
4901   else if (type->isArrayType())
4902     sz = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4903   return sz;
4904 }
4905 
4906 bool ASTContext::isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(const VarDecl *VD) const {
4907   return getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
4908          VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
4909          !VD->getFirstDecl()->isOutOfLine() && VD->getFirstDecl()->hasInit();
4910 }
4911 
4912 static inline
4913 std::string charUnitsToString(const CharUnits &CU) {
4914   return llvm::itostr(CU.getQuantity());
4915 }
4916 
4917 /// getObjCEncodingForBlock - Return the encoded type for this block
4918 /// declaration.
4919 std::string ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForBlock(const BlockExpr *Expr) const {
4920   std::string S;
4921 
4922   const BlockDecl *Decl = Expr->getBlockDecl();
4923   QualType BlockTy =
4924       Expr->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4925   // Encode result type.
4926   if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
4927     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(
4928         Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S,
4929         true /*Extended*/);
4930   else
4931     getObjCEncodingForType(BlockTy->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(), S);
4932   // Compute size of all parameters.
4933   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
4934   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
4935   SourceLocation Loc;
4936   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
4937   CharUnits ParmOffset = PtrSize;
4938   for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4939     QualType PType = PI->getType();
4940     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4941     if (sz.isZero())
4942       continue;
4943     assert (sz.isPositive() && "BlockExpr - Incomplete param type");
4944     ParmOffset += sz;
4945   }
4946   // Size of the argument frame
4947   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4948   // Block pointer and offset.
4949   S += "@?0";
4950 
4951   // Argument types.
4952   ParmOffset = PtrSize;
4953   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
4954     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4955     if (const ArrayType *AT =
4956           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4957       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
4958       // elements.
4959       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
4960         PType = PVDecl->getType();
4961     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
4962       PType = PVDecl->getType();
4963     if (getLangOpts().EncodeExtendedBlockSig)
4964       getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::OBJC_TQ_None, PType,
4965                                       S, true /*Extended*/);
4966     else
4967       getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
4968     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4969     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4970   }
4971 
4972   return S;
4973 }
4974 
4975 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl(const FunctionDecl *Decl,
4976                                                 std::string& S) {
4977   // Encode result type.
4978   getObjCEncodingForType(Decl->getReturnType(), S);
4979   CharUnits ParmOffset;
4980   // Compute size of all parameters.
4981   for (auto PI : Decl->params()) {
4982     QualType PType = PI->getType();
4983     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
4984     if (sz.isZero())
4985       continue;
4986 
4987     assert (sz.isPositive() &&
4988         "getObjCEncodingForFunctionDecl - Incomplete param type");
4989     ParmOffset += sz;
4990   }
4991   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
4992   ParmOffset = CharUnits::Zero();
4993 
4994   // Argument types.
4995   for (auto PVDecl : Decl->params()) {
4996     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
4997     if (const ArrayType *AT =
4998           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
4999       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5000       // elements.
5001       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5002         PType = PVDecl->getType();
5003     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5004       PType = PVDecl->getType();
5005     getObjCEncodingForType(PType, S);
5006     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5007     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5008   }
5009 
5010   return false;
5011 }
5012 
5013 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter - Return the encoded type for a single
5014 /// method parameter or return type. If Extended, include class names and
5015 /// block object types.
5016 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5017                                                    QualType T, std::string& S,
5018                                                    bool Extended) const {
5019   // Encode type qualifer, 'in', 'inout', etc. for the parameter.
5020   getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(QT, S);
5021   // Encode parameter type.
5022   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5023                              true     /*OutermostType*/,
5024                              false    /*EncodingProperty*/,
5025                              false    /*StructField*/,
5026                              Extended /*EncodeBlockParameters*/,
5027                              Extended /*EncodeClassNames*/);
5028 }
5029 
5030 /// getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Return the encoded type for this method
5031 /// declaration.
5032 bool ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl(const ObjCMethodDecl *Decl,
5033                                               std::string& S,
5034                                               bool Extended) const {
5035   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5036   // Encode return type.
5037   getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(Decl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5038                                     Decl->getReturnType(), S, Extended);
5039   // Compute size of all parameters.
5040   // Start with computing size of a pointer in number of bytes.
5041   // FIXME: There might(should) be a better way of doing this computation!
5042   SourceLocation Loc;
5043   CharUnits PtrSize = getTypeSizeInChars(VoidPtrTy);
5044   // The first two arguments (self and _cmd) are pointers; account for
5045   // their size.
5046   CharUnits ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5047   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5048        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5049     QualType PType = (*PI)->getType();
5050     CharUnits sz = getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5051     if (sz.isZero())
5052       continue;
5053 
5054     assert (sz.isPositive() &&
5055         "getObjCEncodingForMethodDecl - Incomplete param type");
5056     ParmOffset += sz;
5057   }
5058   S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5059   S += "@0:";
5060   S += charUnitsToString(PtrSize);
5061 
5062   // Argument types.
5063   ParmOffset = 2 * PtrSize;
5064   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator PI = Decl->param_begin(),
5065        E = Decl->sel_param_end(); PI != E; ++PI) {
5066     const ParmVarDecl *PVDecl = *PI;
5067     QualType PType = PVDecl->getOriginalType();
5068     if (const ArrayType *AT =
5069           dyn_cast<ArrayType>(PType->getCanonicalTypeInternal())) {
5070       // Use array's original type only if it has known number of
5071       // elements.
5072       if (!isa<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5073         PType = PVDecl->getType();
5074     } else if (PType->isFunctionType())
5075       PType = PVDecl->getType();
5076     getObjCEncodingForMethodParameter(PVDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier(),
5077                                       PType, S, Extended);
5078     S += charUnitsToString(ParmOffset);
5079     ParmOffset += getObjCEncodingTypeSize(PType);
5080   }
5081 
5082   return false;
5083 }
5084 
5085 ObjCPropertyImplDecl *
5086 ASTContext::getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(
5087                                       const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5088                                       const Decl *Container) const {
5089   if (!Container)
5090     return nullptr;
5091   if (const ObjCCategoryImplDecl *CID =
5092       dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(Container)) {
5093     for (auto *PID : CID->property_impls())
5094       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5095         return PID;
5096   } else {
5097     const ObjCImplementationDecl *OID=cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(Container);
5098     for (auto *PID : OID->property_impls())
5099       if (PID->getPropertyDecl() == PD)
5100         return PID;
5101   }
5102   return nullptr;
5103 }
5104 
5105 /// getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl - Return the encoded type for this
5106 /// property declaration. If non-NULL, Container must be either an
5107 /// ObjCCategoryImplDecl or ObjCImplementationDecl; it should only be
5108 /// NULL when getting encodings for protocol properties.
5109 /// Property attributes are stored as a comma-delimited C string. The simple
5110 /// attributes readonly and bycopy are encoded as single characters. The
5111 /// parametrized attributes, getter=name, setter=name, and ivar=name, are
5112 /// encoded as single characters, followed by an identifier. Property types
5113 /// are also encoded as a parametrized attribute. The characters used to encode
5114 /// these attributes are defined by the following enumeration:
5115 /// @code
5116 /// enum PropertyAttributes {
5117 /// kPropertyReadOnly = 'R',   // property is read-only.
5118 /// kPropertyBycopy = 'C',     // property is a copy of the value last assigned
5119 /// kPropertyByref = '&',  // property is a reference to the value last assigned
5120 /// kPropertyDynamic = 'D',    // property is dynamic
5121 /// kPropertyGetter = 'G',     // followed by getter selector name
5122 /// kPropertySetter = 'S',     // followed by setter selector name
5123 /// kPropertyInstanceVariable = 'V'  // followed by instance variable  name
5124 /// kPropertyType = 'T'              // followed by old-style type encoding.
5125 /// kPropertyWeak = 'W'              // 'weak' property
5126 /// kPropertyStrong = 'P'            // property GC'able
5127 /// kPropertyNonAtomic = 'N'         // property non-atomic
5128 /// };
5129 /// @endcode
5130 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyDecl(const ObjCPropertyDecl *PD,
5131                                                 const Decl *Container,
5132                                                 std::string& S) const {
5133   // Collect information from the property implementation decl(s).
5134   bool Dynamic = false;
5135   ObjCPropertyImplDecl *SynthesizePID = nullptr;
5136 
5137   if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PropertyImpDecl =
5138       getObjCPropertyImplDeclForPropertyDecl(PD, Container)) {
5139     if (PropertyImpDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
5140       Dynamic = true;
5141     else
5142       SynthesizePID = PropertyImpDecl;
5143   }
5144 
5145   // FIXME: This is not very efficient.
5146   S = "T";
5147 
5148   // Encode result type.
5149   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5150   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5151   getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(PD->getType(), S);
5152 
5153   if (PD->isReadOnly()) {
5154     S += ",R";
5155     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_copy)
5156       S += ",C";
5157     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_retain)
5158       S += ",&";
5159     if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_weak)
5160       S += ",W";
5161   } else {
5162     switch (PD->getSetterKind()) {
5163     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Assign: break;
5164     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Copy:   S += ",C"; break;
5165     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Retain: S += ",&"; break;
5166     case ObjCPropertyDecl::Weak:   S += ",W"; break;
5167     }
5168   }
5169 
5170   // It really isn't clear at all what this means, since properties
5171   // are "dynamic by default".
5172   if (Dynamic)
5173     S += ",D";
5174 
5175   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_nonatomic)
5176     S += ",N";
5177 
5178   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_getter) {
5179     S += ",G";
5180     S += PD->getGetterName().getAsString();
5181   }
5182 
5183   if (PD->getPropertyAttributes() & ObjCPropertyDecl::OBJC_PR_setter) {
5184     S += ",S";
5185     S += PD->getSetterName().getAsString();
5186   }
5187 
5188   if (SynthesizePID) {
5189     const ObjCIvarDecl *OID = SynthesizePID->getPropertyIvarDecl();
5190     S += ",V";
5191     S += OID->getNameAsString();
5192   }
5193 
5194   // FIXME: OBJCGC: weak & strong
5195 }
5196 
5197 /// getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding -
5198 /// Another legacy compatibility encoding: 32-bit longs are encoded as
5199 /// 'l' or 'L' , but not always.  For typedefs, we need to use
5200 /// 'i' or 'I' instead if encoding a struct field, or a pointer!
5201 ///
5202 void ASTContext::getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding (QualType &PointeeTy) const {
5203   if (isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr())) {
5204     if (const BuiltinType *BT = PointeeTy->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5205       if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::ULong && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5206         PointeeTy = UnsignedIntTy;
5207       else
5208         if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Long && getIntWidth(PointeeTy) == 32)
5209           PointeeTy = IntTy;
5210     }
5211   }
5212 }
5213 
5214 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForType(QualType T, std::string& S,
5215                                         const FieldDecl *Field,
5216                                         QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5217   // We follow the behavior of gcc, expanding structures which are
5218   // directly pointed to, and expanding embedded structures. Note that
5219   // these rules are sufficient to prevent recursive encoding of the
5220   // same type.
5221   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, Field,
5222                              true /* outermost type */, false, false,
5223                              false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5224 }
5225 
5226 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForPropertyType(QualType T,
5227                                                 std::string& S) const {
5228   // Encode result type.
5229   // GCC has some special rules regarding encoding of properties which
5230   // closely resembles encoding of ivars.
5231   getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(T, S, true, true, nullptr,
5232                              true /* outermost type */,
5233                              true /* encoding property */);
5234 }
5235 
5236 static char getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(const ASTContext *C,
5237                                             BuiltinType::Kind kind) {
5238     switch (kind) {
5239     case BuiltinType::Void:       return 'v';
5240     case BuiltinType::Bool:       return 'B';
5241     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
5242     case BuiltinType::UChar:      return 'C';
5243     case BuiltinType::Char16:
5244     case BuiltinType::UShort:     return 'S';
5245     case BuiltinType::Char32:
5246     case BuiltinType::UInt:       return 'I';
5247     case BuiltinType::ULong:
5248         return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'L' : 'Q';
5249     case BuiltinType::UInt128:    return 'T';
5250     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:  return 'Q';
5251     case BuiltinType::Char_S:
5252     case BuiltinType::SChar:      return 'c';
5253     case BuiltinType::Short:      return 's';
5254     case BuiltinType::WChar_S:
5255     case BuiltinType::WChar_U:
5256     case BuiltinType::Int:        return 'i';
5257     case BuiltinType::Long:
5258       return C->getTargetInfo().getLongWidth() == 32 ? 'l' : 'q';
5259     case BuiltinType::LongLong:   return 'q';
5260     case BuiltinType::Int128:     return 't';
5261     case BuiltinType::Float:      return 'f';
5262     case BuiltinType::Double:     return 'd';
5263     case BuiltinType::LongDouble: return 'D';
5264     case BuiltinType::NullPtr:    return '*'; // like char*
5265 
5266     case BuiltinType::Half:
5267       // FIXME: potentially need @encodes for these!
5268       return ' ';
5269 
5270     case BuiltinType::ObjCId:
5271     case BuiltinType::ObjCClass:
5272     case BuiltinType::ObjCSel:
5273       llvm_unreachable("@encoding ObjC primitive type");
5274 
5275     // OpenCL and placeholder types don't need @encodings.
5276     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1d:
5277     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dArray:
5278     case BuiltinType::OCLImage1dBuffer:
5279     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2d:
5280     case BuiltinType::OCLImage2dArray:
5281     case BuiltinType::OCLImage3d:
5282     case BuiltinType::OCLEvent:
5283     case BuiltinType::OCLSampler:
5284     case BuiltinType::Dependent:
5285 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(KIND, ID)
5286 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(KIND, ID) \
5287     case BuiltinType::KIND:
5288 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def"
5289       llvm_unreachable("invalid builtin type for @encode");
5290     }
5291     llvm_unreachable("invalid BuiltinType::Kind value");
5292 }
5293 
5294 static char ObjCEncodingForEnumType(const ASTContext *C, const EnumType *ET) {
5295   EnumDecl *Enum = ET->getDecl();
5296 
5297   // The encoding of an non-fixed enum type is always 'i', regardless of size.
5298   if (!Enum->isFixed())
5299     return 'i';
5300 
5301   // The encoding of a fixed enum type matches its fixed underlying type.
5302   const BuiltinType *BT = Enum->getIntegerType()->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5303   return getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(C, BT->getKind());
5304 }
5305 
5306 static void EncodeBitField(const ASTContext *Ctx, std::string& S,
5307                            QualType T, const FieldDecl *FD) {
5308   assert(FD->isBitField() && "not a bitfield - getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl");
5309   S += 'b';
5310   // The NeXT runtime encodes bit fields as b followed by the number of bits.
5311   // The GNU runtime requires more information; bitfields are encoded as b,
5312   // then the offset (in bits) of the first element, then the type of the
5313   // bitfield, then the size in bits.  For example, in this structure:
5314   //
5315   // struct
5316   // {
5317   //    int integer;
5318   //    int flags:2;
5319   // };
5320   // On a 32-bit system, the encoding for flags would be b2 for the NeXT
5321   // runtime, but b32i2 for the GNU runtime.  The reason for this extra
5322   // information is not especially sensible, but we're stuck with it for
5323   // compatibility with GCC, although providing it breaks anything that
5324   // actually uses runtime introspection and wants to work on both runtimes...
5325   if (Ctx->getLangOpts().ObjCRuntime.isGNUFamily()) {
5326     const RecordDecl *RD = FD->getParent();
5327     const ASTRecordLayout &RL = Ctx->getASTRecordLayout(RD);
5328     S += llvm::utostr(RL.getFieldOffset(FD->getFieldIndex()));
5329     if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
5330       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(Ctx, ET);
5331     else {
5332       const BuiltinType *BT = T->castAs<BuiltinType>();
5333       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(Ctx, BT->getKind());
5334     }
5335   }
5336   S += llvm::utostr(FD->getBitWidthValue(*Ctx));
5337 }
5338 
5339 // FIXME: Use SmallString for accumulating string.
5340 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(QualType T, std::string& S,
5341                                             bool ExpandPointedToStructures,
5342                                             bool ExpandStructures,
5343                                             const FieldDecl *FD,
5344                                             bool OutermostType,
5345                                             bool EncodingProperty,
5346                                             bool StructField,
5347                                             bool EncodeBlockParameters,
5348                                             bool EncodeClassNames,
5349                                             bool EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5350                                             QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5351   CanQualType CT = getCanonicalType(T);
5352   switch (CT->getTypeClass()) {
5353   case Type::Builtin:
5354   case Type::Enum:
5355     if (FD && FD->isBitField())
5356       return EncodeBitField(this, S, T, FD);
5357     if (const BuiltinType *BT = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(CT))
5358       S += getObjCEncodingForPrimitiveKind(this, BT->getKind());
5359     else
5360       S += ObjCEncodingForEnumType(this, cast<EnumType>(CT));
5361     return;
5362 
5363   case Type::Complex: {
5364     const ComplexType *CT = T->castAs<ComplexType>();
5365     S += 'j';
5366     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(CT->getElementType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5367     return;
5368   }
5369 
5370   case Type::Atomic: {
5371     const AtomicType *AT = T->castAs<AtomicType>();
5372     S += 'A';
5373     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getValueType(), S, false, false, nullptr);
5374     return;
5375   }
5376 
5377   // encoding for pointer or reference types.
5378   case Type::Pointer:
5379   case Type::LValueReference:
5380   case Type::RValueReference: {
5381     QualType PointeeTy;
5382     if (isa<PointerType>(CT)) {
5383       const PointerType *PT = T->castAs<PointerType>();
5384       if (PT->isObjCSelType()) {
5385         S += ':';
5386         return;
5387       }
5388       PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType();
5389     } else {
5390       PointeeTy = T->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5391     }
5392 
5393     bool isReadOnly = false;
5394     // For historical/compatibility reasons, the read-only qualifier of the
5395     // pointee gets emitted _before_ the '^'.  The read-only qualifier of
5396     // the pointer itself gets ignored, _unless_ we are looking at a typedef!
5397     // Also, do not emit the 'r' for anything but the outermost type!
5398     if (isa<TypedefType>(T.getTypePtr())) {
5399       if (OutermostType && T.isConstQualified()) {
5400         isReadOnly = true;
5401         S += 'r';
5402       }
5403     } else if (OutermostType) {
5404       QualType P = PointeeTy;
5405       while (P->getAs<PointerType>())
5406         P = P->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5407       if (P.isConstQualified()) {
5408         isReadOnly = true;
5409         S += 'r';
5410       }
5411     }
5412     if (isReadOnly) {
5413       // Another legacy compatibility encoding. Some ObjC qualifier and type
5414       // combinations need to be rearranged.
5415       // Rewrite "in const" from "nr" to "rn"
5416       if (StringRef(S).endswith("nr"))
5417         S.replace(S.end()-2, S.end(), "rn");
5418     }
5419 
5420     if (PointeeTy->isCharType()) {
5421       // char pointer types should be encoded as '*' unless it is a
5422       // type that has been typedef'd to 'BOOL'.
5423       if (!isTypeTypedefedAsBOOL(PointeeTy)) {
5424         S += '*';
5425         return;
5426       }
5427     } else if (const RecordType *RTy = PointeeTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
5428       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_class *" to "#".
5429       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_class")) {
5430         S += '#';
5431         return;
5432       }
5433       // GCC binary compat: Need to convert "struct objc_object *" to "@".
5434       if (RTy->getDecl()->getIdentifier() == &Idents.get("objc_object")) {
5435         S += '@';
5436         return;
5437       }
5438       // fall through...
5439     }
5440     S += '^';
5441     getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(PointeeTy);
5442 
5443     getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S, false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5444                                nullptr, false, false, false, false, false, false,
5445                                NotEncodedT);
5446     return;
5447   }
5448 
5449   case Type::ConstantArray:
5450   case Type::IncompleteArray:
5451   case Type::VariableArray: {
5452     const ArrayType *AT = cast<ArrayType>(CT);
5453 
5454     if (isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT) && !StructField) {
5455       // Incomplete arrays are encoded as a pointer to the array element.
5456       S += '^';
5457 
5458       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5459                                  false, ExpandStructures, FD);
5460     } else {
5461       S += '[';
5462 
5463       if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
5464         S += llvm::utostr(CAT->getSize().getZExtValue());
5465       else {
5466         //Variable length arrays are encoded as a regular array with 0 elements.
5467         assert((isa<VariableArrayType>(AT) || isa<IncompleteArrayType>(AT)) &&
5468                "Unknown array type!");
5469         S += '0';
5470       }
5471 
5472       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(AT->getElementType(), S,
5473                                  false, ExpandStructures, FD,
5474                                  false, false, false, false, false, false,
5475                                  NotEncodedT);
5476       S += ']';
5477     }
5478     return;
5479   }
5480 
5481   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
5482   case Type::FunctionProto:
5483     S += '?';
5484     return;
5485 
5486   case Type::Record: {
5487     RecordDecl *RDecl = cast<RecordType>(CT)->getDecl();
5488     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? '(' : '{';
5489     // Anonymous structures print as '?'
5490     if (const IdentifierInfo *II = RDecl->getIdentifier()) {
5491       S += II->getName();
5492       if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
5493           = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RDecl)) {
5494         const TemplateArgumentList &TemplateArgs = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
5495         llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(S);
5496         TemplateSpecializationType::PrintTemplateArgumentList(OS,
5497                                             TemplateArgs.data(),
5498                                             TemplateArgs.size(),
5499                                             (*this).getPrintingPolicy());
5500       }
5501     } else {
5502       S += '?';
5503     }
5504     if (ExpandStructures) {
5505       S += '=';
5506       if (!RDecl->isUnion()) {
5507         getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RDecl, S, FD, true, NotEncodedT);
5508       } else {
5509         for (const auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5510           if (FD) {
5511             S += '"';
5512             S += Field->getNameAsString();
5513             S += '"';
5514           }
5515 
5516           // Special case bit-fields.
5517           if (Field->isBitField()) {
5518             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true,
5519                                        Field);
5520           } else {
5521             QualType qt = Field->getType();
5522             getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5523             getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true,
5524                                        FD, /*OutermostType*/false,
5525                                        /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5526                                        /*StructField*/true,
5527                                        false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5528           }
5529         }
5530       }
5531     }
5532     S += RDecl->isUnion() ? ')' : '}';
5533     return;
5534   }
5535 
5536   case Type::BlockPointer: {
5537     const BlockPointerType *BT = T->castAs<BlockPointerType>();
5538     S += "@?"; // Unlike a pointer-to-function, which is "^?".
5539     if (EncodeBlockParameters) {
5540       const FunctionType *FT = BT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
5541 
5542       S += '<';
5543       // Block return type
5544       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5545           FT->getReturnType(), S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures,
5546           FD, false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5547           false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames, false,
5548                                  NotEncodedT);
5549       // Block self
5550       S += "@?";
5551       // Block parameters
5552       if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
5553         for (const auto &I : FPT->param_types())
5554           getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(
5555               I, S, ExpandPointedToStructures, ExpandStructures, FD,
5556               false /* OutermostType */, EncodingProperty,
5557               false /* StructField */, EncodeBlockParameters, EncodeClassNames,
5558                                      false, NotEncodedT);
5559       }
5560       S += '>';
5561     }
5562     return;
5563   }
5564 
5565   case Type::ObjCObject: {
5566     // hack to match legacy encoding of *id and *Class
5567     QualType Ty = getObjCObjectPointerType(CT);
5568     if (Ty->isObjCIdType()) {
5569       S += "{objc_object=}";
5570       return;
5571     }
5572     else if (Ty->isObjCClassType()) {
5573       S += "{objc_class=}";
5574       return;
5575     }
5576   }
5577 
5578   case Type::ObjCInterface: {
5579     // Ignore protocol qualifiers when mangling at this level.
5580     T = T->castAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getBaseType();
5581 
5582     // The assumption seems to be that this assert will succeed
5583     // because nested levels will have filtered out 'id' and 'Class'.
5584     const ObjCInterfaceType *OIT = T->castAs<ObjCInterfaceType>();
5585     // @encode(class_name)
5586     ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OIT->getDecl();
5587     S += '{';
5588     const IdentifierInfo *II = OI->getIdentifier();
5589     S += II->getName();
5590     S += '=';
5591     SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5592     DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5593     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5594       const FieldDecl *Field = cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]);
5595       if (Field->isBitField())
5596         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, Field);
5597       else
5598         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(Field->getType(), S, false, true, FD,
5599                                    false, false, false, false, false,
5600                                    EncodePointerToObjCTypedef,
5601                                    NotEncodedT);
5602     }
5603     S += '}';
5604     return;
5605   }
5606 
5607   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
5608     const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = T->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
5609     if (OPT->isObjCIdType()) {
5610       S += '@';
5611       return;
5612     }
5613 
5614     if (OPT->isObjCClassType() || OPT->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) {
5615       // FIXME: Consider if we need to output qualifiers for 'Class<p>'.
5616       // Since this is a binary compatibility issue, need to consult with runtime
5617       // folks. Fortunately, this is a *very* obsure construct.
5618       S += '#';
5619       return;
5620     }
5621 
5622     if (OPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
5623       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(getObjCIdType(), S,
5624                                  ExpandPointedToStructures,
5625                                  ExpandStructures, FD);
5626       if (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames) {
5627         // Note that we do extended encoding of protocol qualifer list
5628         // Only when doing ivar or property encoding.
5629         S += '"';
5630         for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5631           S += '<';
5632           S += I->getNameAsString();
5633           S += '>';
5634         }
5635         S += '"';
5636       }
5637       return;
5638     }
5639 
5640     QualType PointeeTy = OPT->getPointeeType();
5641     if (!EncodingProperty &&
5642         isa<TypedefType>(PointeeTy.getTypePtr()) &&
5643         !EncodePointerToObjCTypedef) {
5644       // Another historical/compatibility reason.
5645       // We encode the underlying type which comes out as
5646       // {...};
5647       S += '^';
5648       if (FD && OPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
5649         // Prevent recursive encoding of fields in some rare cases.
5650         ObjCInterfaceDecl *OI = OPT->getInterfaceDecl();
5651         SmallVector<const ObjCIvarDecl*, 32> Ivars;
5652         DeepCollectObjCIvars(OI, true, Ivars);
5653         for (unsigned i = 0, e = Ivars.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5654           if (cast<FieldDecl>(Ivars[i]) == FD) {
5655             S += '{';
5656             S += OI->getIdentifier()->getName();
5657             S += '}';
5658             return;
5659           }
5660         }
5661       }
5662       getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(PointeeTy, S,
5663                                  false, ExpandPointedToStructures,
5664                                  nullptr,
5665                                  false, false, false, false, false,
5666                                  /*EncodePointerToObjCTypedef*/true);
5667       return;
5668     }
5669 
5670     S += '@';
5671     if (OPT->getInterfaceDecl() &&
5672         (FD || EncodingProperty || EncodeClassNames)) {
5673       S += '"';
5674       S += OPT->getInterfaceDecl()->getIdentifier()->getName();
5675       for (const auto *I : OPT->quals()) {
5676         S += '<';
5677         S += I->getNameAsString();
5678         S += '>';
5679       }
5680       S += '"';
5681     }
5682     return;
5683   }
5684 
5685   // gcc just blithely ignores member pointers.
5686   // FIXME: we shoul do better than that.  'M' is available.
5687   case Type::MemberPointer:
5688   // This matches gcc's encoding, even though technically it is insufficient.
5689   //FIXME. We should do a better job than gcc.
5690   case Type::Vector:
5691   case Type::ExtVector:
5692   // Until we have a coherent encoding of these three types, issue warning.
5693     { if (NotEncodedT)
5694         *NotEncodedT = T;
5695       return;
5696     }
5697 
5698   // We could see an undeduced auto type here during error recovery.
5699   // Just ignore it.
5700   case Type::Auto:
5701     return;
5702 
5703 
5704 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5705 #define TYPE(KIND, BASE)
5706 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5707   case Type::KIND:
5708 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5709   case Type::KIND:
5710 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(KIND, BASE) \
5711   case Type::KIND:
5712 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
5713     llvm_unreachable("@encode for dependent type!");
5714   }
5715   llvm_unreachable("bad type kind!");
5716 }
5717 
5718 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(RecordDecl *RDecl,
5719                                                  std::string &S,
5720                                                  const FieldDecl *FD,
5721                                                  bool includeVBases,
5722                                                  QualType *NotEncodedT) const {
5723   assert(RDecl && "Expected non-null RecordDecl");
5724   assert(!RDecl->isUnion() && "Should not be called for unions");
5725   if (!RDecl->getDefinition())
5726     return;
5727 
5728   CXXRecordDecl *CXXRec = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RDecl);
5729   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *> FieldOrBaseOffsets;
5730   const ASTRecordLayout &layout = getASTRecordLayout(RDecl);
5731 
5732   if (CXXRec) {
5733     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->bases()) {
5734       if (!BI.isVirtual()) {
5735         CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5736         if (base->isEmpty())
5737           continue;
5738         uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getBaseClassOffset(base));
5739         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5740                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
5741       }
5742     }
5743   }
5744 
5745   unsigned i = 0;
5746   for (auto *Field : RDecl->fields()) {
5747     uint64_t offs = layout.getFieldOffset(i);
5748     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5749                               std::make_pair(offs, Field));
5750     ++i;
5751   }
5752 
5753   if (CXXRec && includeVBases) {
5754     for (const auto &BI : CXXRec->vbases()) {
5755       CXXRecordDecl *base = BI.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
5756       if (base->isEmpty())
5757         continue;
5758       uint64_t offs = toBits(layout.getVBaseClassOffset(base));
5759       if (offs >= uint64_t(toBits(layout.getNonVirtualSize())) &&
5760           FieldOrBaseOffsets.find(offs) == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end())
5761         FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(),
5762                                   std::make_pair(offs, base));
5763     }
5764   }
5765 
5766   CharUnits size;
5767   if (CXXRec) {
5768     size = includeVBases ? layout.getSize() : layout.getNonVirtualSize();
5769   } else {
5770     size = layout.getSize();
5771   }
5772 
5773 #ifndef NDEBUG
5774   uint64_t CurOffs = 0;
5775 #endif
5776   std::multimap<uint64_t, NamedDecl *>::iterator
5777     CurLayObj = FieldOrBaseOffsets.begin();
5778 
5779   if (CXXRec && CXXRec->isDynamicClass() &&
5780       (CurLayObj == FieldOrBaseOffsets.end() || CurLayObj->first != 0)) {
5781     if (FD) {
5782       S += "\"_vptr$";
5783       std::string recname = CXXRec->getNameAsString();
5784       if (recname.empty()) recname = "?";
5785       S += recname;
5786       S += '"';
5787     }
5788     S += "^^?";
5789 #ifndef NDEBUG
5790     CurOffs += getTypeSize(VoidPtrTy);
5791 #endif
5792   }
5793 
5794   if (!RDecl->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
5795     // Mark the end of the structure.
5796     uint64_t offs = toBits(size);
5797     FieldOrBaseOffsets.insert(FieldOrBaseOffsets.upper_bound(offs),
5798                               std::make_pair(offs, nullptr));
5799   }
5800 
5801   for (; CurLayObj != FieldOrBaseOffsets.end(); ++CurLayObj) {
5802 #ifndef NDEBUG
5803     assert(CurOffs <= CurLayObj->first);
5804     if (CurOffs < CurLayObj->first) {
5805       uint64_t padding = CurLayObj->first - CurOffs;
5806       // FIXME: There doesn't seem to be a way to indicate in the encoding that
5807       // packing/alignment of members is different that normal, in which case
5808       // the encoding will be out-of-sync with the real layout.
5809       // If the runtime switches to just consider the size of types without
5810       // taking into account alignment, we could make padding explicit in the
5811       // encoding (e.g. using arrays of chars). The encoding strings would be
5812       // longer then though.
5813       CurOffs += padding;
5814     }
5815 #endif
5816 
5817     NamedDecl *dcl = CurLayObj->second;
5818     if (!dcl)
5819       break; // reached end of structure.
5820 
5821     if (CXXRecordDecl *base = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(dcl)) {
5822       // We expand the bases without their virtual bases since those are going
5823       // in the initial structure. Note that this differs from gcc which
5824       // expands virtual bases each time one is encountered in the hierarchy,
5825       // making the encoding type bigger than it really is.
5826       getObjCEncodingForStructureImpl(base, S, FD, /*includeVBases*/false,
5827                                       NotEncodedT);
5828       assert(!base->isEmpty());
5829 #ifndef NDEBUG
5830       CurOffs += toBits(getASTRecordLayout(base).getNonVirtualSize());
5831 #endif
5832     } else {
5833       FieldDecl *field = cast<FieldDecl>(dcl);
5834       if (FD) {
5835         S += '"';
5836         S += field->getNameAsString();
5837         S += '"';
5838       }
5839 
5840       if (field->isBitField()) {
5841         EncodeBitField(this, S, field->getType(), field);
5842 #ifndef NDEBUG
5843         CurOffs += field->getBitWidthValue(*this);
5844 #endif
5845       } else {
5846         QualType qt = field->getType();
5847         getLegacyIntegralTypeEncoding(qt);
5848         getObjCEncodingForTypeImpl(qt, S, false, true, FD,
5849                                    /*OutermostType*/false,
5850                                    /*EncodingProperty*/false,
5851                                    /*StructField*/true,
5852                                    false, false, false, NotEncodedT);
5853 #ifndef NDEBUG
5854         CurOffs += getTypeSize(field->getType());
5855 #endif
5856       }
5857     }
5858   }
5859 }
5860 
5861 void ASTContext::getObjCEncodingForTypeQualifier(Decl::ObjCDeclQualifier QT,
5862                                                  std::string& S) const {
5863   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_In)
5864     S += 'n';
5865   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Inout)
5866     S += 'N';
5867   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Out)
5868     S += 'o';
5869   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Bycopy)
5870     S += 'O';
5871   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Byref)
5872     S += 'R';
5873   if (QT & Decl::OBJC_TQ_Oneway)
5874     S += 'V';
5875 }
5876 
5877 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCIdDecl() const {
5878   if (!ObjCIdDecl) {
5879     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinIdTy, nullptr, 0);
5880     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5881     ObjCIdDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "id");
5882   }
5883   return ObjCIdDecl;
5884 }
5885 
5886 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCSelDecl() const {
5887   if (!ObjCSelDecl) {
5888     QualType T = getPointerType(ObjCBuiltinSelTy);
5889     ObjCSelDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "SEL");
5890   }
5891   return ObjCSelDecl;
5892 }
5893 
5894 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getObjCClassDecl() const {
5895   if (!ObjCClassDecl) {
5896     QualType T = getObjCObjectType(ObjCBuiltinClassTy, nullptr, 0);
5897     T = getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
5898     ObjCClassDecl = buildImplicitTypedef(T, "Class");
5899   }
5900   return ObjCClassDecl;
5901 }
5902 
5903 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ASTContext::getObjCProtocolDecl() const {
5904   if (!ObjCProtocolClassDecl) {
5905     ObjCProtocolClassDecl
5906       = ObjCInterfaceDecl::Create(*this, getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5907                                   SourceLocation(),
5908                                   &Idents.get("Protocol"),
5909                                   /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
5910                                   SourceLocation(), true);
5911   }
5912 
5913   return ObjCProtocolClassDecl;
5914 }
5915 
5916 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5917 // __builtin_va_list Construction Functions
5918 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5919 
5920 static TypedefDecl *CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5921   // typedef char* __builtin_va_list;
5922   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->CharTy);
5923   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
5924 }
5925 
5926 static TypedefDecl *CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5927   // typedef void* __builtin_va_list;
5928   QualType T = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5929   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
5930 }
5931 
5932 static TypedefDecl *
5933 CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5934   // struct __va_list
5935   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
5936   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5937     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
5938     NamespaceDecl *NS;
5939     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5940                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
5941                                /*Inline*/ false, SourceLocation(),
5942                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
5943                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
5944     NS->setImplicit();
5945     VaListTagDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
5946   }
5947 
5948   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
5949 
5950   const size_t NumFields = 5;
5951   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
5952   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
5953 
5954   // void *__stack;
5955   FieldTypes[0] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5956   FieldNames[0] = "__stack";
5957 
5958   // void *__gr_top;
5959   FieldTypes[1] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5960   FieldNames[1] = "__gr_top";
5961 
5962   // void *__vr_top;
5963   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
5964   FieldNames[2] = "__vr_top";
5965 
5966   // int __gr_offs;
5967   FieldTypes[3] = Context->IntTy;
5968   FieldNames[3] = "__gr_offs";
5969 
5970   // int __vr_offs;
5971   FieldTypes[4] = Context->IntTy;
5972   FieldNames[4] = "__vr_offs";
5973 
5974   // Create fields
5975   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
5976     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
5977                                          VaListTagDecl,
5978                                          SourceLocation(),
5979                                          SourceLocation(),
5980                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
5981                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
5982                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
5983                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
5984                                          ICIS_NoInit);
5985     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
5986     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
5987   }
5988   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
5989   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
5990   Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
5991 
5992   // } __builtin_va_list;
5993   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__builtin_va_list");
5994 }
5995 
5996 static TypedefDecl *CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
5997   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
5998   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
5999 
6000   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6001   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6002 
6003   const size_t NumFields = 5;
6004   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6005   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6006 
6007   //   unsigned char gpr;
6008   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6009   FieldNames[0] = "gpr";
6010 
6011   //   unsigned char fpr;
6012   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedCharTy;
6013   FieldNames[1] = "fpr";
6014 
6015   //   unsigned short reserved;
6016   FieldTypes[2] = Context->UnsignedShortTy;
6017   FieldNames[2] = "reserved";
6018 
6019   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
6020   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6021   FieldNames[3] = "overflow_arg_area";
6022 
6023   //   void* reg_save_area;
6024   FieldTypes[4] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6025   FieldNames[4] = "reg_save_area";
6026 
6027   // Create fields
6028   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6029     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(*Context, VaListTagDecl,
6030                                          SourceLocation(),
6031                                          SourceLocation(),
6032                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6033                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6034                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6035                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6036                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6037     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6038     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6039   }
6040   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6041   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6042   Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6043 
6044   // } __va_list_tag;
6045   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6046       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6047 
6048   QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6049     Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6050 
6051   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6052   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6053   QualType VaListTagArrayType
6054     = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6055                                     Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6056   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6057 }
6058 
6059 static TypedefDecl *
6060 CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6061   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6062   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6063   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6064   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6065 
6066   const size_t NumFields = 4;
6067   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6068   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6069 
6070   //   unsigned gp_offset;
6071   FieldTypes[0] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6072   FieldNames[0] = "gp_offset";
6073 
6074   //   unsigned fp_offset;
6075   FieldTypes[1] = Context->UnsignedIntTy;
6076   FieldNames[1] = "fp_offset";
6077 
6078   //   void* overflow_arg_area;
6079   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6080   FieldNames[2] = "overflow_arg_area";
6081 
6082   //   void* reg_save_area;
6083   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6084   FieldNames[3] = "reg_save_area";
6085 
6086   // Create fields
6087   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6088     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6089                                          VaListTagDecl,
6090                                          SourceLocation(),
6091                                          SourceLocation(),
6092                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6093                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6094                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6095                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6096                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6097     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6098     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6099   }
6100   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6101   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6102   Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6103 
6104   // } __va_list_tag;
6105   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6106       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6107 
6108   QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6109     Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6110 
6111   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6112   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6113   QualType VaListTagArrayType
6114     = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6115                                       Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6116   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6117 }
6118 
6119 static TypedefDecl *CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6120   // typedef int __builtin_va_list[4];
6121   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 4);
6122   QualType IntArrayType
6123     = Context->getConstantArrayType(Context->IntTy,
6124 				    Size, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6125   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(IntArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6126 }
6127 
6128 static TypedefDecl *
6129 CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6130   // struct __va_list
6131   RecordDecl *VaListDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list");
6132   if (Context->getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6133     // namespace std { struct __va_list {
6134     NamespaceDecl *NS;
6135     NS = NamespaceDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6136                                Context->getTranslationUnitDecl(),
6137                                /*Inline*/false, SourceLocation(),
6138                                SourceLocation(), &Context->Idents.get("std"),
6139                                /*PrevDecl*/ nullptr);
6140     NS->setImplicit();
6141     VaListDecl->setDeclContext(NS);
6142   }
6143 
6144   VaListDecl->startDefinition();
6145 
6146   // void * __ap;
6147   FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6148                                        VaListDecl,
6149                                        SourceLocation(),
6150                                        SourceLocation(),
6151                                        &Context->Idents.get("__ap"),
6152                                        Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy),
6153                                        /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6154                                        /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6155                                        /*Mutable=*/false,
6156                                        ICIS_NoInit);
6157   Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6158   VaListDecl->addDecl(Field);
6159 
6160   // };
6161   VaListDecl->completeDefinition();
6162 
6163   // typedef struct __va_list __builtin_va_list;
6164   QualType T = Context->getRecordType(VaListDecl);
6165   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(T, "__builtin_va_list");
6166 }
6167 
6168 static TypedefDecl *
6169 CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context) {
6170   // typedef struct __va_list_tag {
6171   RecordDecl *VaListTagDecl;
6172   VaListTagDecl = Context->buildImplicitRecord("__va_list_tag");
6173   VaListTagDecl->startDefinition();
6174 
6175   const size_t NumFields = 4;
6176   QualType FieldTypes[NumFields];
6177   const char *FieldNames[NumFields];
6178 
6179   //   long __gpr;
6180   FieldTypes[0] = Context->LongTy;
6181   FieldNames[0] = "__gpr";
6182 
6183   //   long __fpr;
6184   FieldTypes[1] = Context->LongTy;
6185   FieldNames[1] = "__fpr";
6186 
6187   //   void *__overflow_arg_area;
6188   FieldTypes[2] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6189   FieldNames[2] = "__overflow_arg_area";
6190 
6191   //   void *__reg_save_area;
6192   FieldTypes[3] = Context->getPointerType(Context->VoidTy);
6193   FieldNames[3] = "__reg_save_area";
6194 
6195   // Create fields
6196   for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumFields; ++i) {
6197     FieldDecl *Field = FieldDecl::Create(const_cast<ASTContext &>(*Context),
6198                                          VaListTagDecl,
6199                                          SourceLocation(),
6200                                          SourceLocation(),
6201                                          &Context->Idents.get(FieldNames[i]),
6202                                          FieldTypes[i], /*TInfo=*/nullptr,
6203                                          /*BitWidth=*/nullptr,
6204                                          /*Mutable=*/false,
6205                                          ICIS_NoInit);
6206     Field->setAccess(AS_public);
6207     VaListTagDecl->addDecl(Field);
6208   }
6209   VaListTagDecl->completeDefinition();
6210   QualType VaListTagType = Context->getRecordType(VaListTagDecl);
6211   Context->VaListTagTy = VaListTagType;
6212 
6213   // } __va_list_tag;
6214   TypedefDecl *VaListTagTypedefDecl =
6215       Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagType, "__va_list_tag");
6216   QualType VaListTagTypedefType =
6217     Context->getTypedefType(VaListTagTypedefDecl);
6218 
6219   // typedef __va_list_tag __builtin_va_list[1];
6220   llvm::APInt Size(Context->getTypeSize(Context->getSizeType()), 1);
6221   QualType VaListTagArrayType
6222     = Context->getConstantArrayType(VaListTagTypedefType,
6223                                       Size, ArrayType::Normal,0);
6224 
6225   return Context->buildImplicitTypedef(VaListTagArrayType, "__builtin_va_list");
6226 }
6227 
6228 static TypedefDecl *CreateVaListDecl(const ASTContext *Context,
6229                                      TargetInfo::BuiltinVaListKind Kind) {
6230   switch (Kind) {
6231   case TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList:
6232     return CreateCharPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6233   case TargetInfo::VoidPtrBuiltinVaList:
6234     return CreateVoidPtrBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6235   case TargetInfo::AArch64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6236     return CreateAArch64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6237   case TargetInfo::PowerABIBuiltinVaList:
6238     return CreatePowerABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6239   case TargetInfo::X86_64ABIBuiltinVaList:
6240     return CreateX86_64ABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6241   case TargetInfo::PNaClABIBuiltinVaList:
6242     return CreatePNaClABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6243   case TargetInfo::AAPCSABIBuiltinVaList:
6244     return CreateAAPCSABIBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6245   case TargetInfo::SystemZBuiltinVaList:
6246     return CreateSystemZBuiltinVaListDecl(Context);
6247   }
6248 
6249   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled __builtin_va_list type kind");
6250 }
6251 
6252 TypedefDecl *ASTContext::getBuiltinVaListDecl() const {
6253   if (!BuiltinVaListDecl) {
6254     BuiltinVaListDecl = CreateVaListDecl(this, Target->getBuiltinVaListKind());
6255     assert(BuiltinVaListDecl->isImplicit());
6256   }
6257 
6258   return BuiltinVaListDecl;
6259 }
6260 
6261 QualType ASTContext::getVaListTagType() const {
6262   // Force the creation of VaListTagTy by building the __builtin_va_list
6263   // declaration.
6264   if (VaListTagTy.isNull())
6265     (void) getBuiltinVaListDecl();
6266 
6267   return VaListTagTy;
6268 }
6269 
6270 void ASTContext::setObjCConstantStringInterface(ObjCInterfaceDecl *Decl) {
6271   assert(ObjCConstantStringType.isNull() &&
6272          "'NSConstantString' type already set!");
6273 
6274   ObjCConstantStringType = getObjCInterfaceType(Decl);
6275 }
6276 
6277 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that corresponds to a non-empty
6278 /// lookup.
6279 TemplateName
6280 ASTContext::getOverloadedTemplateName(UnresolvedSetIterator Begin,
6281                                       UnresolvedSetIterator End) const {
6282   unsigned size = End - Begin;
6283   assert(size > 1 && "set is not overloaded!");
6284 
6285   void *memory = Allocate(sizeof(OverloadedTemplateStorage) +
6286                           size * sizeof(FunctionTemplateDecl*));
6287   OverloadedTemplateStorage *OT = new(memory) OverloadedTemplateStorage(size);
6288 
6289   NamedDecl **Storage = OT->getStorage();
6290   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = Begin; I != End; ++I) {
6291     NamedDecl *D = *I;
6292     assert(isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) ||
6293            (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) &&
6294             isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D->getUnderlyingDecl())));
6295     *Storage++ = D;
6296   }
6297 
6298   return TemplateName(OT);
6299 }
6300 
6301 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a qualified
6302 /// template name such as \c std::vector.
6303 TemplateName
6304 ASTContext::getQualifiedTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6305                                      bool TemplateKeyword,
6306                                      TemplateDecl *Template) const {
6307   assert(NNS && "Missing nested-name-specifier in qualified template name");
6308 
6309   // FIXME: Canonicalization?
6310   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6311   QualifiedTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6312 
6313   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6314   QualifiedTemplateName *QTN =
6315     QualifiedTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6316   if (!QTN) {
6317     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<QualifiedTemplateName>())
6318         QualifiedTemplateName(NNS, TemplateKeyword, Template);
6319     QualifiedTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6320   }
6321 
6322   return TemplateName(QTN);
6323 }
6324 
6325 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6326 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template apply.
6327 TemplateName
6328 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6329                                      const IdentifierInfo *Name) const {
6330   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6331          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6332 
6333   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6334   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Name);
6335 
6336   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6337   DependentTemplateName *QTN =
6338     DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6339 
6340   if (QTN)
6341     return TemplateName(QTN);
6342 
6343   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6344   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6345     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6346         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name);
6347   } else {
6348     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Name);
6349     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6350         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Name, Canon);
6351     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN =
6352       DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6353     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent type name canonicalization broken");
6354     (void)CheckQTN;
6355   }
6356 
6357   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6358   return TemplateName(QTN);
6359 }
6360 
6361 /// \brief Retrieve the template name that represents a dependent
6362 /// template name such as \c MetaFun::template operator+.
6363 TemplateName
6364 ASTContext::getDependentTemplateName(NestedNameSpecifier *NNS,
6365                                      OverloadedOperatorKind Operator) const {
6366   assert((!NNS || NNS->isDependent()) &&
6367          "Nested name specifier must be dependent");
6368 
6369   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6370   DependentTemplateName::Profile(ID, NNS, Operator);
6371 
6372   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6373   DependentTemplateName *QTN
6374     = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6375 
6376   if (QTN)
6377     return TemplateName(QTN);
6378 
6379   NestedNameSpecifier *CanonNNS = getCanonicalNestedNameSpecifier(NNS);
6380   if (CanonNNS == NNS) {
6381     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6382         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator);
6383   } else {
6384     TemplateName Canon = getDependentTemplateName(CanonNNS, Operator);
6385     QTN = new (*this, llvm::alignOf<DependentTemplateName>())
6386         DependentTemplateName(NNS, Operator, Canon);
6387 
6388     DependentTemplateName *CheckQTN
6389       = DependentTemplateNames.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6390     assert(!CheckQTN && "Dependent template name canonicalization broken");
6391     (void)CheckQTN;
6392   }
6393 
6394   DependentTemplateNames.InsertNode(QTN, InsertPos);
6395   return TemplateName(QTN);
6396 }
6397 
6398 TemplateName
6399 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParm(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *param,
6400                                          TemplateName replacement) const {
6401   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6402   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage::Profile(ID, param, replacement);
6403 
6404   void *insertPos = nullptr;
6405   SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage *subst
6406     = SubstTemplateTemplateParms.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, insertPos);
6407 
6408   if (!subst) {
6409     subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmStorage(param, replacement);
6410     SubstTemplateTemplateParms.InsertNode(subst, insertPos);
6411   }
6412 
6413   return TemplateName(subst);
6414 }
6415 
6416 TemplateName
6417 ASTContext::getSubstTemplateTemplateParmPack(TemplateTemplateParmDecl *Param,
6418                                        const TemplateArgument &ArgPack) const {
6419   ASTContext &Self = const_cast<ASTContext &>(*this);
6420   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID ID;
6421   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage::Profile(ID, Self, Param, ArgPack);
6422 
6423   void *InsertPos = nullptr;
6424   SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage *Subst
6425     = SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.FindNodeOrInsertPos(ID, InsertPos);
6426 
6427   if (!Subst) {
6428     Subst = new (*this) SubstTemplateTemplateParmPackStorage(Param,
6429                                                            ArgPack.pack_size(),
6430                                                          ArgPack.pack_begin());
6431     SubstTemplateTemplateParmPacks.InsertNode(Subst, InsertPos);
6432   }
6433 
6434   return TemplateName(Subst);
6435 }
6436 
6437 /// getFromTargetType - Given one of the integer types provided by
6438 /// TargetInfo, produce the corresponding type. The unsigned @p Type
6439 /// is actually a value of type @c TargetInfo::IntType.
6440 CanQualType ASTContext::getFromTargetType(unsigned Type) const {
6441   switch (Type) {
6442   case TargetInfo::NoInt: return CanQualType();
6443   case TargetInfo::SignedChar: return SignedCharTy;
6444   case TargetInfo::UnsignedChar: return UnsignedCharTy;
6445   case TargetInfo::SignedShort: return ShortTy;
6446   case TargetInfo::UnsignedShort: return UnsignedShortTy;
6447   case TargetInfo::SignedInt: return IntTy;
6448   case TargetInfo::UnsignedInt: return UnsignedIntTy;
6449   case TargetInfo::SignedLong: return LongTy;
6450   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLong: return UnsignedLongTy;
6451   case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong: return LongLongTy;
6452   case TargetInfo::UnsignedLongLong: return UnsignedLongLongTy;
6453   }
6454 
6455   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::IntType value");
6456 }
6457 
6458 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6459 //                        Type Predicates.
6460 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6461 
6462 /// getObjCGCAttr - Returns one of GCNone, Weak or Strong objc's
6463 /// garbage collection attribute.
6464 ///
6465 Qualifiers::GC ASTContext::getObjCGCAttrKind(QualType Ty) const {
6466   if (getLangOpts().getGC() == LangOptions::NonGC)
6467     return Qualifiers::GCNone;
6468 
6469   assert(getLangOpts().ObjC1);
6470   Qualifiers::GC GCAttrs = Ty.getObjCGCAttr();
6471 
6472   // Default behaviour under objective-C's gc is for ObjC pointers
6473   // (or pointers to them) be treated as though they were declared
6474   // as __strong.
6475   if (GCAttrs == Qualifiers::GCNone) {
6476     if (Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType() || Ty->isBlockPointerType())
6477       return Qualifiers::Strong;
6478     else if (Ty->isPointerType())
6479       return getObjCGCAttrKind(Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
6480   } else {
6481     // It's not valid to set GC attributes on anything that isn't a
6482     // pointer.
6483 #ifndef NDEBUG
6484     QualType CT = Ty->getCanonicalTypeInternal();
6485     while (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CT))
6486       CT = AT->getElementType();
6487     assert(CT->isAnyPointerType() || CT->isBlockPointerType());
6488 #endif
6489   }
6490   return GCAttrs;
6491 }
6492 
6493 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6494 //                        Type Compatibility Testing
6495 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6496 
6497 /// areCompatVectorTypes - Return true if the two specified vector types are
6498 /// compatible.
6499 static bool areCompatVectorTypes(const VectorType *LHS,
6500                                  const VectorType *RHS) {
6501   assert(LHS->isCanonicalUnqualified() && RHS->isCanonicalUnqualified());
6502   return LHS->getElementType() == RHS->getElementType() &&
6503          LHS->getNumElements() == RHS->getNumElements();
6504 }
6505 
6506 bool ASTContext::areCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType FirstVec,
6507                                           QualType SecondVec) {
6508   assert(FirstVec->isVectorType() && "FirstVec should be a vector type");
6509   assert(SecondVec->isVectorType() && "SecondVec should be a vector type");
6510 
6511   if (hasSameUnqualifiedType(FirstVec, SecondVec))
6512     return true;
6513 
6514   // Treat Neon vector types and most AltiVec vector types as if they are the
6515   // equivalent GCC vector types.
6516   const VectorType *First = FirstVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6517   const VectorType *Second = SecondVec->getAs<VectorType>();
6518   if (First->getNumElements() == Second->getNumElements() &&
6519       hasSameType(First->getElementType(), Second->getElementType()) &&
6520       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6521       First->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool &&
6522       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecPixel &&
6523       Second->getVectorKind() != VectorType::AltiVecBool)
6524     return true;
6525 
6526   return false;
6527 }
6528 
6529 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6530 // ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - Compatibility testing for qualified id's.
6531 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6532 
6533 /// ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol - return 'true' if 'lProto' is in the
6534 /// inheritance hierarchy of 'rProto'.
6535 bool
6536 ASTContext::ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(ObjCProtocolDecl *lProto,
6537                                            ObjCProtocolDecl *rProto) const {
6538   if (declaresSameEntity(lProto, rProto))
6539     return true;
6540   for (auto *PI : rProto->protocols())
6541     if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lProto, PI))
6542       return true;
6543   return false;
6544 }
6545 
6546 /// ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible - compare  Class<pr,...> and
6547 /// Class<pr1, ...>.
6548 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs,
6549                                                       QualType rhs) {
6550   const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6551   const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6552   assert ((lhsQID && rhsOPT) && "ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible");
6553 
6554   for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6555     bool match = false;
6556     for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6557       if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto)) {
6558         match = true;
6559         break;
6560       }
6561     }
6562     if (!match)
6563       return false;
6564   }
6565   return true;
6566 }
6567 
6568 /// ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible - We know that one of lhs/rhs is an
6569 /// ObjCQualifiedIDType.
6570 bool ASTContext::ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6571                                                    bool compare) {
6572   // Allow id<P..> and an 'id' or void* type in all cases.
6573   if (lhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6574       lhs->isObjCIdType() || lhs->isObjCClassType())
6575     return true;
6576   else if (rhs->isVoidPointerType() ||
6577            rhs->isObjCIdType() || rhs->isObjCClassType())
6578     return true;
6579 
6580   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsQID = lhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType()) {
6581     const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsOPT = rhs->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6582 
6583     if (!rhsOPT) return false;
6584 
6585     if (rhsOPT->qual_empty()) {
6586       // If the RHS is a unqualified interface pointer "NSString*",
6587       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6588       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6589         for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6590           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6591           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6592           // through its super class and categories.
6593           if (!rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true))
6594             return false;
6595         }
6596       }
6597       // If there are no qualifiers and no interface, we have an 'id'.
6598       return true;
6599     }
6600     // Both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6601     for (auto *lhsProto : lhsQID->quals()) {
6602       bool match = false;
6603 
6604       // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6605       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6606       // through its super class and categories.
6607       for (auto *rhsProto : rhsOPT->quals()) {
6608         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6609             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6610           match = true;
6611           break;
6612         }
6613       }
6614       // If the RHS is a qualified interface pointer "NSString<P>*",
6615       // make sure we check the class hierarchy.
6616       if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *rhsID = rhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6617         for (auto *I : lhsQID->quals()) {
6618           // when comparing an id<P> on lhs with a static type on rhs,
6619           // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6620           // through its super class and categories.
6621           if (rhsID->ClassImplementsProtocol(I, true)) {
6622             match = true;
6623             break;
6624           }
6625         }
6626       }
6627       if (!match)
6628         return false;
6629     }
6630 
6631     return true;
6632   }
6633 
6634   const ObjCObjectPointerType *rhsQID = rhs->getAsObjCQualifiedIdType();
6635   assert(rhsQID && "One of the LHS/RHS should be id<x>");
6636 
6637   if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *lhsOPT =
6638         lhs->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType()) {
6639     // If both the right and left sides have qualifiers.
6640     for (auto *lhsProto : lhsOPT->quals()) {
6641       bool match = false;
6642 
6643       // when comparing an id<P> on rhs with a static type on lhs,
6644       // see if static class implements all of id's protocols, directly or
6645       // through its super class and categories.
6646       // First, lhs protocols in the qualifier list must be found, direct
6647       // or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6648       for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6649         if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6650             (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6651           match = true;
6652           break;
6653         }
6654       }
6655       if (!match)
6656         return false;
6657     }
6658 
6659     // Static class's protocols, or its super class or category protocols
6660     // must be found, direct or indirect in rhs's qualifier list or it is a mismatch.
6661     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *lhsID = lhsOPT->getInterfaceDecl()) {
6662       llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6663       CollectInheritedProtocols(lhsID, LHSInheritedProtocols);
6664       // This is rather dubious but matches gcc's behavior. If lhs has
6665       // no type qualifier and its class has no static protocol(s)
6666       // assume that it is mismatch.
6667       if (LHSInheritedProtocols.empty() && lhsOPT->qual_empty())
6668         return false;
6669       for (auto *lhsProto : LHSInheritedProtocols) {
6670         bool match = false;
6671         for (auto *rhsProto : rhsQID->quals()) {
6672           if (ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(lhsProto, rhsProto) ||
6673               (compare && ProtocolCompatibleWithProtocol(rhsProto, lhsProto))) {
6674             match = true;
6675             break;
6676           }
6677         }
6678         if (!match)
6679           return false;
6680       }
6681     }
6682     return true;
6683   }
6684   return false;
6685 }
6686 
6687 /// canAssignObjCInterfaces - Return true if the two interface types are
6688 /// compatible for assignment from RHS to LHS.  This handles validation of any
6689 /// protocol qualifiers on the LHS or RHS.
6690 ///
6691 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6692                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT) {
6693   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6694   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6695 
6696   // If either type represents the built-in 'id' or 'Class' types, return true.
6697   if (LHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass() ||
6698       RHS->isObjCUnqualifiedIdOrClass())
6699     return true;
6700 
6701   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedId() || RHS->isObjCQualifiedId())
6702     return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6703                                              QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6704                                              false);
6705 
6706   if (LHS->isObjCQualifiedClass() && RHS->isObjCQualifiedClass())
6707     return ObjCQualifiedClassTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6708                                                 QualType(RHSOPT,0));
6709 
6710   // If we have 2 user-defined types, fall into that path.
6711   if (LHS->getInterface() && RHS->getInterface())
6712     return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS);
6713 
6714   return false;
6715 }
6716 
6717 /// canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer - This routine is specifically written
6718 /// for providing type-safety for objective-c pointers used to pass/return
6719 /// arguments in block literals. When passed as arguments, passing 'A*' where
6720 /// 'id' is expected is not OK. Passing 'Sub *" where 'Super *" is expected is
6721 /// not OK. For the return type, the opposite is not OK.
6722 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
6723                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6724                                          const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6725                                          bool BlockReturnType) {
6726   if (RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || LHSOPT->isObjCIdType())
6727     return true;
6728 
6729   if (LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
6730     return RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType();
6731   }
6732 
6733   if (LHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSOPT->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
6734     return ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(QualType(LHSOPT,0),
6735                                              QualType(RHSOPT,0),
6736                                              false);
6737 
6738   const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = LHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6739   const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = RHSOPT->getInterfaceType();
6740   if (LHS && RHS)  { // We have 2 user-defined types.
6741     if (LHS != RHS) {
6742       if (LHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getDecl()))
6743         return BlockReturnType;
6744       if (RHS->getDecl()->isSuperClassOf(LHS->getDecl()))
6745         return !BlockReturnType;
6746     }
6747     else
6748       return true;
6749   }
6750   return false;
6751 }
6752 
6753 /// getIntersectionOfProtocols - This routine finds the intersection of set
6754 /// of protocols inherited from two distinct objective-c pointer objects.
6755 /// It is used to build composite qualifier list of the composite type of
6756 /// the conditional expression involving two objective-c pointer objects.
6757 static
6758 void getIntersectionOfProtocols(ASTContext &Context,
6759                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT,
6760                                 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT,
6761       SmallVectorImpl<ObjCProtocolDecl *> &IntersectionOfProtocols) {
6762 
6763   const ObjCObjectType* LHS = LHSOPT->getObjectType();
6764   const ObjCObjectType* RHS = RHSOPT->getObjectType();
6765   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS must have an interface base");
6766   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS must have an interface base");
6767 
6768   llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> InheritedProtocolSet;
6769   unsigned LHSNumProtocols = LHS->getNumProtocols();
6770   if (LHSNumProtocols > 0)
6771     InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHS->qual_begin(), LHS->qual_end());
6772   else {
6773     llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> LHSInheritedProtocols;
6774     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(LHS->getInterface(),
6775                                       LHSInheritedProtocols);
6776     InheritedProtocolSet.insert(LHSInheritedProtocols.begin(),
6777                                 LHSInheritedProtocols.end());
6778   }
6779 
6780   unsigned RHSNumProtocols = RHS->getNumProtocols();
6781   if (RHSNumProtocols > 0) {
6782     ObjCProtocolDecl **RHSProtocols =
6783       const_cast<ObjCProtocolDecl **>(RHS->qual_begin());
6784     for (unsigned i = 0; i < RHSNumProtocols; ++i)
6785       if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(RHSProtocols[i]))
6786         IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(RHSProtocols[i]);
6787   } else {
6788     llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> RHSInheritedProtocols;
6789     Context.CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(),
6790                                       RHSInheritedProtocols);
6791     for (ObjCProtocolDecl *ProtDecl : RHSInheritedProtocols)
6792       if (InheritedProtocolSet.count(ProtDecl))
6793         IntersectionOfProtocols.push_back(ProtDecl);
6794   }
6795 }
6796 
6797 /// areCommonBaseCompatible - Returns common base class of the two classes if
6798 /// one found. Note that this is O'2 algorithm. But it will be called as the
6799 /// last type comparison in a ?-exp of ObjC pointer types before a
6800 /// warning is issued. So, its invokation is extremely rare.
6801 QualType ASTContext::areCommonBaseCompatible(
6802                                           const ObjCObjectPointerType *Lptr,
6803                                           const ObjCObjectPointerType *Rptr) {
6804   const ObjCObjectType *LHS = Lptr->getObjectType();
6805   const ObjCObjectType *RHS = Rptr->getObjectType();
6806   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* LDecl = LHS->getInterface();
6807   const ObjCInterfaceDecl* RDecl = RHS->getInterface();
6808   if (!LDecl || !RDecl || (declaresSameEntity(LDecl, RDecl)))
6809     return QualType();
6810 
6811   do {
6812     LHS = cast<ObjCInterfaceType>(getObjCInterfaceType(LDecl));
6813     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS, RHS)) {
6814       SmallVector<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> Protocols;
6815       getIntersectionOfProtocols(*this, Lptr, Rptr, Protocols);
6816 
6817       QualType Result = QualType(LHS, 0);
6818       if (!Protocols.empty())
6819         Result = getObjCObjectType(Result, Protocols.data(), Protocols.size());
6820       Result = getObjCObjectPointerType(Result);
6821       return Result;
6822     }
6823   } while ((LDecl = LDecl->getSuperClass()));
6824 
6825   return QualType();
6826 }
6827 
6828 bool ASTContext::canAssignObjCInterfaces(const ObjCObjectType *LHS,
6829                                          const ObjCObjectType *RHS) {
6830   assert(LHS->getInterface() && "LHS is not an interface type");
6831   assert(RHS->getInterface() && "RHS is not an interface type");
6832 
6833   // Verify that the base decls are compatible: the RHS must be a subclass of
6834   // the LHS.
6835   if (!LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface()))
6836     return false;
6837 
6838   // RHS must have a superset of the protocols in the LHS.  If the LHS is not
6839   // protocol qualified at all, then we are good.
6840   if (LHS->getNumProtocols() == 0)
6841     return true;
6842 
6843   // Okay, we know the LHS has protocol qualifiers. But RHS may or may not.
6844   // More detailed analysis is required.
6845   // OK, if LHS is same or a superclass of RHS *and*
6846   // this LHS, or as RHS's super class is assignment compatible with LHS.
6847   bool IsSuperClass =
6848     LHS->getInterface()->isSuperClassOf(RHS->getInterface());
6849   if (IsSuperClass) {
6850     // OK if conversion of LHS to SuperClass results in narrowing of types
6851     // ; i.e., SuperClass may implement at least one of the protocols
6852     // in LHS's protocol list. Example, SuperObj<P1> = lhs<P1,P2> is ok.
6853     // But not SuperObj<P1,P2,P3> = lhs<P1,P2>.
6854     llvm::SmallPtrSet<ObjCProtocolDecl *, 8> SuperClassInheritedProtocols;
6855     CollectInheritedProtocols(RHS->getInterface(), SuperClassInheritedProtocols);
6856     // Also, if RHS has explicit quelifiers, include them for comparing with LHS's
6857     // qualifiers.
6858     for (auto *RHSPI : RHS->quals())
6859       SuperClassInheritedProtocols.insert(RHSPI->getCanonicalDecl());
6860     // If there is no protocols associated with RHS, it is not a match.
6861     if (SuperClassInheritedProtocols.empty())
6862       return false;
6863 
6864     for (const auto *LHSProto : LHS->quals()) {
6865       bool SuperImplementsProtocol = false;
6866       for (auto *SuperClassProto : SuperClassInheritedProtocols)
6867         if (SuperClassProto->lookupProtocolNamed(LHSProto->getIdentifier())) {
6868           SuperImplementsProtocol = true;
6869           break;
6870         }
6871       if (!SuperImplementsProtocol)
6872         return false;
6873     }
6874     return true;
6875   }
6876   return false;
6877 }
6878 
6879 bool ASTContext::areComparableObjCPointerTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6880   // get the "pointed to" types
6881   const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6882   const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6883 
6884   if (!LHSOPT || !RHSOPT)
6885     return false;
6886 
6887   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT) ||
6888          canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT);
6889 }
6890 
6891 bool ASTContext::canBindObjCObjectType(QualType To, QualType From) {
6892   return canAssignObjCInterfaces(
6893                 getObjCObjectPointerType(To)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
6894                 getObjCObjectPointerType(From)->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>());
6895 }
6896 
6897 /// typesAreCompatible - C99 6.7.3p9: For two qualified types to be compatible,
6898 /// both shall have the identically qualified version of a compatible type.
6899 /// C99 6.2.7p1: Two types have compatible types if their types are the
6900 /// same. See 6.7.[2,3,5] for additional rules.
6901 bool ASTContext::typesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
6902                                     bool CompareUnqualified) {
6903   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6904     return hasSameType(LHS, RHS);
6905 
6906   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, false, CompareUnqualified).isNull();
6907 }
6908 
6909 bool ASTContext::propertyTypesAreCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6910   return typesAreCompatible(LHS, RHS);
6911 }
6912 
6913 bool ASTContext::typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
6914   return !mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true).isNull();
6915 }
6916 
6917 /// mergeTransparentUnionType - if T is a transparent union type and a member
6918 /// of T is compatible with SubType, return the merged type, else return
6919 /// QualType()
6920 QualType ASTContext::mergeTransparentUnionType(QualType T, QualType SubType,
6921                                                bool OfBlockPointer,
6922                                                bool Unqualified) {
6923   if (const RecordType *UT = T->getAsUnionType()) {
6924     RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
6925     if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
6926       for (const auto *I : UD->fields()) {
6927         QualType ET = I->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
6928         QualType MT = mergeTypes(ET, SubType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6929         if (!MT.isNull())
6930           return MT;
6931       }
6932     }
6933   }
6934 
6935   return QualType();
6936 }
6937 
6938 /// mergeFunctionParameterTypes - merge two types which appear as function
6939 /// parameter types
6940 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionParameterTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6941                                                  bool OfBlockPointer,
6942                                                  bool Unqualified) {
6943   // GNU extension: two types are compatible if they appear as a function
6944   // argument, one of the types is a transparent union type and the other
6945   // type is compatible with a union member
6946   QualType lmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer,
6947                                               Unqualified);
6948   if (!lmerge.isNull())
6949     return lmerge;
6950 
6951   QualType rmerge = mergeTransparentUnionType(rhs, lhs, OfBlockPointer,
6952                                               Unqualified);
6953   if (!rmerge.isNull())
6954     return rmerge;
6955 
6956   return mergeTypes(lhs, rhs, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
6957 }
6958 
6959 QualType ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(QualType lhs, QualType rhs,
6960                                         bool OfBlockPointer,
6961                                         bool Unqualified) {
6962   const FunctionType *lbase = lhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6963   const FunctionType *rbase = rhs->getAs<FunctionType>();
6964   const FunctionProtoType *lproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(lbase);
6965   const FunctionProtoType *rproto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(rbase);
6966   bool allLTypes = true;
6967   bool allRTypes = true;
6968 
6969   // Check return type
6970   QualType retType;
6971   if (OfBlockPointer) {
6972     QualType RHS = rbase->getReturnType();
6973     QualType LHS = lbase->getReturnType();
6974     bool UnqualifiedResult = Unqualified;
6975     if (!UnqualifiedResult)
6976       UnqualifiedResult = (!RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers());
6977     retType = mergeTypes(LHS, RHS, true, UnqualifiedResult, true);
6978   }
6979   else
6980     retType = mergeTypes(lbase->getReturnType(), rbase->getReturnType(), false,
6981                          Unqualified);
6982   if (retType.isNull()) return QualType();
6983 
6984   if (Unqualified)
6985     retType = retType.getUnqualifiedType();
6986 
6987   CanQualType LRetType = getCanonicalType(lbase->getReturnType());
6988   CanQualType RRetType = getCanonicalType(rbase->getReturnType());
6989   if (Unqualified) {
6990     LRetType = LRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6991     RRetType = RRetType.getUnqualifiedType();
6992   }
6993 
6994   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != LRetType)
6995     allLTypes = false;
6996   if (getCanonicalType(retType) != RRetType)
6997     allRTypes = false;
6998 
6999   // FIXME: double check this
7000   // FIXME: should we error if lbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7001   //                           rbase->getRegParmAttr() != 0 &&
7002   //                           lbase->getRegParmAttr() != rbase->getRegParmAttr()?
7003   FunctionType::ExtInfo lbaseInfo = lbase->getExtInfo();
7004   FunctionType::ExtInfo rbaseInfo = rbase->getExtInfo();
7005 
7006   // Compatible functions must have compatible calling conventions
7007   if (lbaseInfo.getCC() != rbaseInfo.getCC())
7008     return QualType();
7009 
7010   // Regparm is part of the calling convention.
7011   if (lbaseInfo.getHasRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getHasRegParm())
7012     return QualType();
7013   if (lbaseInfo.getRegParm() != rbaseInfo.getRegParm())
7014     return QualType();
7015 
7016   if (lbaseInfo.getProducesResult() != rbaseInfo.getProducesResult())
7017     return QualType();
7018 
7019   // FIXME: some uses, e.g. conditional exprs, really want this to be 'both'.
7020   bool NoReturn = lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() || rbaseInfo.getNoReturn();
7021 
7022   if (lbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7023     allLTypes = false;
7024   if (rbaseInfo.getNoReturn() != NoReturn)
7025     allRTypes = false;
7026 
7027   FunctionType::ExtInfo einfo = lbaseInfo.withNoReturn(NoReturn);
7028 
7029   if (lproto && rproto) { // two C99 style function prototypes
7030     assert(!lproto->hasExceptionSpec() && !rproto->hasExceptionSpec() &&
7031            "C++ shouldn't be here");
7032     // Compatible functions must have the same number of parameters
7033     if (lproto->getNumParams() != rproto->getNumParams())
7034       return QualType();
7035 
7036     // Variadic and non-variadic functions aren't compatible
7037     if (lproto->isVariadic() != rproto->isVariadic())
7038       return QualType();
7039 
7040     if (lproto->getTypeQuals() != rproto->getTypeQuals())
7041       return QualType();
7042 
7043     if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
7044         !FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(rproto, lproto))
7045       return QualType();
7046 
7047     // Check parameter type compatibility
7048     SmallVector<QualType, 10> types;
7049     for (unsigned i = 0, n = lproto->getNumParams(); i < n; i++) {
7050       QualType lParamType = lproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7051       QualType rParamType = rproto->getParamType(i).getUnqualifiedType();
7052       QualType paramType = mergeFunctionParameterTypes(
7053           lParamType, rParamType, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7054       if (paramType.isNull())
7055         return QualType();
7056 
7057       if (Unqualified)
7058         paramType = paramType.getUnqualifiedType();
7059 
7060       types.push_back(paramType);
7061       if (Unqualified) {
7062         lParamType = lParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7063         rParamType = rParamType.getUnqualifiedType();
7064       }
7065 
7066       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(lParamType))
7067         allLTypes = false;
7068       if (getCanonicalType(paramType) != getCanonicalType(rParamType))
7069         allRTypes = false;
7070     }
7071 
7072     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7073     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7074 
7075     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = lproto->getExtProtoInfo();
7076     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7077     return getFunctionType(retType, types, EPI);
7078   }
7079 
7080   if (lproto) allRTypes = false;
7081   if (rproto) allLTypes = false;
7082 
7083   const FunctionProtoType *proto = lproto ? lproto : rproto;
7084   if (proto) {
7085     assert(!proto->hasExceptionSpec() && "C++ shouldn't be here");
7086     if (proto->isVariadic()) return QualType();
7087     // Check that the types are compatible with the types that
7088     // would result from default argument promotions (C99 6.7.5.3p15).
7089     // The only types actually affected are promotable integer
7090     // types and floats, which would be passed as a different
7091     // type depending on whether the prototype is visible.
7092     for (unsigned i = 0, n = proto->getNumParams(); i < n; ++i) {
7093       QualType paramTy = proto->getParamType(i);
7094 
7095       // Look at the converted type of enum types, since that is the type used
7096       // to pass enum values.
7097       if (const EnumType *Enum = paramTy->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7098         paramTy = Enum->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7099         if (paramTy.isNull())
7100           return QualType();
7101       }
7102 
7103       if (paramTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ||
7104           getCanonicalType(paramTy).getUnqualifiedType() == FloatTy)
7105         return QualType();
7106     }
7107 
7108     if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7109     if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7110 
7111     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = proto->getExtProtoInfo();
7112     EPI.ExtInfo = einfo;
7113     return getFunctionType(retType, proto->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7114   }
7115 
7116   if (allLTypes) return lhs;
7117   if (allRTypes) return rhs;
7118   return getFunctionNoProtoType(retType, einfo);
7119 }
7120 
7121 /// Given that we have an enum type and a non-enum type, try to merge them.
7122 static QualType mergeEnumWithInteger(ASTContext &Context, const EnumType *ET,
7123                                      QualType other, bool isBlockReturnType) {
7124   // C99 6.7.2.2p4: Each enumerated type shall be compatible with char,
7125   // a signed integer type, or an unsigned integer type.
7126   // Compatibility is based on the underlying type, not the promotion
7127   // type.
7128   QualType underlyingType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7129   if (underlyingType.isNull()) return QualType();
7130   if (Context.hasSameType(underlyingType, other))
7131     return other;
7132 
7133   // In block return types, we're more permissive and accept any
7134   // integral type of the same size.
7135   if (isBlockReturnType && other->isIntegerType() &&
7136       Context.getTypeSize(underlyingType) == Context.getTypeSize(other))
7137     return other;
7138 
7139   return QualType();
7140 }
7141 
7142 QualType ASTContext::mergeTypes(QualType LHS, QualType RHS,
7143                                 bool OfBlockPointer,
7144                                 bool Unqualified, bool BlockReturnType) {
7145   // C++ [expr]: If an expression initially has the type "reference to T", the
7146   // type is adjusted to "T" prior to any further analysis, the expression
7147   // designates the object or function denoted by the reference, and the
7148   // expression is an lvalue unless the reference is an rvalue reference and
7149   // the expression is a function call (possibly inside parentheses).
7150   assert(!LHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "LHS is a reference type?");
7151   assert(!RHS->getAs<ReferenceType>() && "RHS is a reference type?");
7152 
7153   if (Unqualified) {
7154     LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7155     RHS = RHS.getUnqualifiedType();
7156   }
7157 
7158   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7159            RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7160 
7161   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7162   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7163     return LHS;
7164 
7165   // If the qualifiers are different, the types aren't compatible... mostly.
7166   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7167   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7168   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7169     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type
7170     // mismatch.
7171     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7172         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace() ||
7173         LQuals.getObjCLifetime() != RQuals.getObjCLifetime())
7174       return QualType();
7175 
7176     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7177     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7178     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
7179     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7180     // qualified __strong.
7181     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7182     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7183     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7184 
7185     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7186       return QualType();
7187 
7188     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7189       return mergeTypes(LHS, getObjCGCQualType(RHS, Qualifiers::Strong));
7190     }
7191     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong && LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7192       return mergeTypes(getObjCGCQualType(LHS, Qualifiers::Strong), RHS);
7193     }
7194     return QualType();
7195   }
7196 
7197   // Okay, qualifiers are equal.
7198 
7199   Type::TypeClass LHSClass = LHSCan->getTypeClass();
7200   Type::TypeClass RHSClass = RHSCan->getTypeClass();
7201 
7202   // We want to consider the two function types to be the same for these
7203   // comparisons, just force one to the other.
7204   if (LHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) LHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7205   if (RHSClass == Type::FunctionProto) RHSClass = Type::FunctionNoProto;
7206 
7207   // Same as above for arrays
7208   if (LHSClass == Type::VariableArray || LHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7209     LHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7210   if (RHSClass == Type::VariableArray || RHSClass == Type::IncompleteArray)
7211     RHSClass = Type::ConstantArray;
7212 
7213   // ObjCInterfaces are just specialized ObjCObjects.
7214   if (LHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) LHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7215   if (RHSClass == Type::ObjCInterface) RHSClass = Type::ObjCObject;
7216 
7217   // Canonicalize ExtVector -> Vector.
7218   if (LHSClass == Type::ExtVector) LHSClass = Type::Vector;
7219   if (RHSClass == Type::ExtVector) RHSClass = Type::Vector;
7220 
7221   // If the canonical type classes don't match.
7222   if (LHSClass != RHSClass) {
7223     // Note that we only have special rules for turning block enum
7224     // returns into block int returns, not vice-versa.
7225     if (const EnumType* ETy = LHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7226       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, RHS, false);
7227     }
7228     if (const EnumType* ETy = RHS->getAs<EnumType>()) {
7229       return mergeEnumWithInteger(*this, ETy, LHS, BlockReturnType);
7230     }
7231     // allow block pointer type to match an 'id' type.
7232     if (OfBlockPointer && !BlockReturnType) {
7233        if (LHS->isObjCIdType() && RHS->isBlockPointerType())
7234          return LHS;
7235       if (RHS->isObjCIdType() && LHS->isBlockPointerType())
7236         return RHS;
7237     }
7238 
7239     return QualType();
7240   }
7241 
7242   // The canonical type classes match.
7243   switch (LHSClass) {
7244 #define TYPE(Class, Base)
7245 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base)
7246 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7247 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7248 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class:
7249 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def"
7250     llvm_unreachable("Non-canonical and dependent types shouldn't get here");
7251 
7252   case Type::Auto:
7253   case Type::LValueReference:
7254   case Type::RValueReference:
7255   case Type::MemberPointer:
7256     llvm_unreachable("C++ should never be in mergeTypes");
7257 
7258   case Type::ObjCInterface:
7259   case Type::IncompleteArray:
7260   case Type::VariableArray:
7261   case Type::FunctionProto:
7262   case Type::ExtVector:
7263     llvm_unreachable("Types are eliminated above");
7264 
7265   case Type::Pointer:
7266   {
7267     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7268     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7269     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7270     if (Unqualified) {
7271       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7272       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7273     }
7274     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, false,
7275                                      Unqualified);
7276     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7277     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7278       return LHS;
7279     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7280       return RHS;
7281     return getPointerType(ResultType);
7282   }
7283   case Type::BlockPointer:
7284   {
7285     // Merge two block pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7286     QualType LHSPointee = LHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7287     QualType RHSPointee = RHS->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7288     if (Unqualified) {
7289       LHSPointee = LHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7290       RHSPointee = RHSPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
7291     }
7292     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSPointee, RHSPointee, OfBlockPointer,
7293                                      Unqualified);
7294     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7295     if (getCanonicalType(LHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7296       return LHS;
7297     if (getCanonicalType(RHSPointee) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7298       return RHS;
7299     return getBlockPointerType(ResultType);
7300   }
7301   case Type::Atomic:
7302   {
7303     // Merge two pointer types, while trying to preserve typedef info
7304     QualType LHSValue = LHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7305     QualType RHSValue = RHS->getAs<AtomicType>()->getValueType();
7306     if (Unqualified) {
7307       LHSValue = LHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7308       RHSValue = RHSValue.getUnqualifiedType();
7309     }
7310     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSValue, RHSValue, false,
7311                                      Unqualified);
7312     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7313     if (getCanonicalType(LHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7314       return LHS;
7315     if (getCanonicalType(RHSValue) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7316       return RHS;
7317     return getAtomicType(ResultType);
7318   }
7319   case Type::ConstantArray:
7320   {
7321     const ConstantArrayType* LCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(LHS);
7322     const ConstantArrayType* RCAT = getAsConstantArrayType(RHS);
7323     if (LCAT && RCAT && RCAT->getSize() != LCAT->getSize())
7324       return QualType();
7325 
7326     QualType LHSElem = getAsArrayType(LHS)->getElementType();
7327     QualType RHSElem = getAsArrayType(RHS)->getElementType();
7328     if (Unqualified) {
7329       LHSElem = LHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7330       RHSElem = RHSElem.getUnqualifiedType();
7331     }
7332 
7333     QualType ResultType = mergeTypes(LHSElem, RHSElem, false, Unqualified);
7334     if (ResultType.isNull()) return QualType();
7335     if (LCAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7336       return LHS;
7337     if (RCAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7338       return RHS;
7339     if (LCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, LCAT->getSize(),
7340                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7341     if (RCAT) return getConstantArrayType(ResultType, RCAT->getSize(),
7342                                           ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7343     const VariableArrayType* LVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(LHS);
7344     const VariableArrayType* RVAT = getAsVariableArrayType(RHS);
7345     if (LVAT && getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7346       return LHS;
7347     if (RVAT && getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType))
7348       return RHS;
7349     if (LVAT) {
7350       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7351       // the array's size has to be the size of LHS, but the type
7352       // has to be different.
7353       return LHS;
7354     }
7355     if (RVAT) {
7356       // FIXME: This isn't correct! But tricky to implement because
7357       // the array's size has to be the size of RHS, but the type
7358       // has to be different.
7359       return RHS;
7360     }
7361     if (getCanonicalType(LHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return LHS;
7362     if (getCanonicalType(RHSElem) == getCanonicalType(ResultType)) return RHS;
7363     return getIncompleteArrayType(ResultType,
7364                                   ArrayType::ArraySizeModifier(), 0);
7365   }
7366   case Type::FunctionNoProto:
7367     return mergeFunctionTypes(LHS, RHS, OfBlockPointer, Unqualified);
7368   case Type::Record:
7369   case Type::Enum:
7370     return QualType();
7371   case Type::Builtin:
7372     // Only exactly equal builtin types are compatible, which is tested above.
7373     return QualType();
7374   case Type::Complex:
7375     // Distinct complex types are incompatible.
7376     return QualType();
7377   case Type::Vector:
7378     // FIXME: The merged type should be an ExtVector!
7379     if (areCompatVectorTypes(LHSCan->getAs<VectorType>(),
7380                              RHSCan->getAs<VectorType>()))
7381       return LHS;
7382     return QualType();
7383   case Type::ObjCObject: {
7384     // Check if the types are assignment compatible.
7385     // FIXME: This should be type compatibility, e.g. whether
7386     // "LHS x; RHS x;" at global scope is legal.
7387     const ObjCObjectType* LHSIface = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7388     const ObjCObjectType* RHSIface = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
7389     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSIface, RHSIface))
7390       return LHS;
7391 
7392     return QualType();
7393   }
7394   case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: {
7395     if (OfBlockPointer) {
7396       if (canAssignObjCInterfacesInBlockPointer(
7397                                           LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7398                                           RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7399                                           BlockReturnType))
7400         return LHS;
7401       return QualType();
7402     }
7403     if (canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
7404                                 RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()))
7405       return LHS;
7406 
7407     return QualType();
7408   }
7409   }
7410 
7411   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Type::Class!");
7412 }
7413 
7414 bool ASTContext::FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(
7415                    const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType,
7416                    const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType) {
7417   if (FromFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams() !=
7418       ToFunctionType->hasAnyConsumedParams())
7419     return false;
7420   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo FromEPI =
7421     FromFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7422   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ToEPI =
7423     ToFunctionType->getExtProtoInfo();
7424   if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters && ToEPI.ConsumedParameters)
7425     for (unsigned i = 0, n = FromFunctionType->getNumParams(); i != n; ++i) {
7426       if (FromEPI.ConsumedParameters[i] != ToEPI.ConsumedParameters[i])
7427         return false;
7428     }
7429   return true;
7430 }
7431 
7432 /// mergeObjCGCQualifiers - This routine merges ObjC's GC attribute of 'LHS' and
7433 /// 'RHS' attributes and returns the merged version; including for function
7434 /// return types.
7435 QualType ASTContext::mergeObjCGCQualifiers(QualType LHS, QualType RHS) {
7436   QualType LHSCan = getCanonicalType(LHS),
7437   RHSCan = getCanonicalType(RHS);
7438   // If two types are identical, they are compatible.
7439   if (LHSCan == RHSCan)
7440     return LHS;
7441   if (RHSCan->isFunctionType()) {
7442     if (!LHSCan->isFunctionType())
7443       return QualType();
7444     QualType OldReturnType =
7445         cast<FunctionType>(RHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7446     QualType NewReturnType =
7447         cast<FunctionType>(LHSCan.getTypePtr())->getReturnType();
7448     QualType ResReturnType =
7449       mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewReturnType, OldReturnType);
7450     if (ResReturnType.isNull())
7451       return QualType();
7452     if (ResReturnType == NewReturnType || ResReturnType == OldReturnType) {
7453       // id foo(); ... __strong id foo(); or: __strong id foo(); ... id foo();
7454       // In either case, use OldReturnType to build the new function type.
7455       const FunctionType *F = LHS->getAs<FunctionType>();
7456       if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(F)) {
7457         FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
7458         EPI.ExtInfo = getFunctionExtInfo(LHS);
7459         QualType ResultType =
7460             getFunctionType(OldReturnType, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI);
7461         return ResultType;
7462       }
7463     }
7464     return QualType();
7465   }
7466 
7467   // If the qualifiers are different, the types can still be merged.
7468   Qualifiers LQuals = LHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7469   Qualifiers RQuals = RHSCan.getLocalQualifiers();
7470   if (LQuals != RQuals) {
7471     // If any of these qualifiers are different, we have a type mismatch.
7472     if (LQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != RQuals.getCVRQualifiers() ||
7473         LQuals.getAddressSpace() != RQuals.getAddressSpace())
7474       return QualType();
7475 
7476     // Exactly one GC qualifier difference is allowed: __strong is
7477     // okay if the other type has no GC qualifier but is an Objective
7478     // C object pointer (i.e. implicitly strong by default).  We fix
7479     // this by pretending that the unqualified type was actually
7480     // qualified __strong.
7481     Qualifiers::GC GC_L = LQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7482     Qualifiers::GC GC_R = RQuals.getObjCGCAttr();
7483     assert((GC_L != GC_R) && "unequal qualifier sets had only equal elements");
7484 
7485     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Weak || GC_R == Qualifiers::Weak)
7486       return QualType();
7487 
7488     if (GC_L == Qualifiers::Strong)
7489       return LHS;
7490     if (GC_R == Qualifiers::Strong)
7491       return RHS;
7492     return QualType();
7493   }
7494 
7495   if (LHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSCan->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
7496     QualType LHSBaseQT = LHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7497     QualType RHSBaseQT = RHS->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
7498     QualType ResQT = mergeObjCGCQualifiers(LHSBaseQT, RHSBaseQT);
7499     if (ResQT == LHSBaseQT)
7500       return LHS;
7501     if (ResQT == RHSBaseQT)
7502       return RHS;
7503   }
7504   return QualType();
7505 }
7506 
7507 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7508 //                         Integer Predicates
7509 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7510 
7511 unsigned ASTContext::getIntWidth(QualType T) const {
7512   if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7513     T = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7514   if (T->isBooleanType())
7515     return 1;
7516   // For builtin types, just use the standard type sizing method
7517   return (unsigned)getTypeSize(T);
7518 }
7519 
7520 QualType ASTContext::getCorrespondingUnsignedType(QualType T) const {
7521   assert(T->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation() && "Unexpected type");
7522 
7523   // Turn <4 x signed int> -> <4 x unsigned int>
7524   if (const VectorType *VTy = T->getAs<VectorType>())
7525     return getVectorType(getCorrespondingUnsignedType(VTy->getElementType()),
7526                          VTy->getNumElements(), VTy->getVectorKind());
7527 
7528   // For enums, we return the unsigned version of the base type.
7529   if (const EnumType *ETy = T->getAs<EnumType>())
7530     T = ETy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7531 
7532   const BuiltinType *BTy = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
7533   assert(BTy && "Unexpected signed integer type");
7534   switch (BTy->getKind()) {
7535   case BuiltinType::Char_S:
7536   case BuiltinType::SChar:
7537     return UnsignedCharTy;
7538   case BuiltinType::Short:
7539     return UnsignedShortTy;
7540   case BuiltinType::Int:
7541     return UnsignedIntTy;
7542   case BuiltinType::Long:
7543     return UnsignedLongTy;
7544   case BuiltinType::LongLong:
7545     return UnsignedLongLongTy;
7546   case BuiltinType::Int128:
7547     return UnsignedInt128Ty;
7548   default:
7549     llvm_unreachable("Unexpected signed integer type");
7550   }
7551 }
7552 
7553 ASTMutationListener::~ASTMutationListener() { }
7554 
7555 void ASTMutationListener::DeducedReturnType(const FunctionDecl *FD,
7556                                             QualType ReturnType) {}
7557 
7558 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7559 //                          Builtin Type Computation
7560 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7561 
7562 /// DecodeTypeFromStr - This decodes one type descriptor from Str, advancing the
7563 /// pointer over the consumed characters.  This returns the resultant type.  If
7564 /// AllowTypeModifiers is false then modifier like * are not parsed, just basic
7565 /// types.  This allows "v2i*" to be parsed as a pointer to a v2i instead of
7566 /// a vector of "i*".
7567 ///
7568 /// RequiresICE is filled in on return to indicate whether the value is required
7569 /// to be an Integer Constant Expression.
7570 static QualType DecodeTypeFromStr(const char *&Str, const ASTContext &Context,
7571                                   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
7572                                   bool &RequiresICE,
7573                                   bool AllowTypeModifiers) {
7574   // Modifiers.
7575   int HowLong = 0;
7576   bool Signed = false, Unsigned = false;
7577   RequiresICE = false;
7578 
7579   // Read the prefixed modifiers first.
7580   bool Done = false;
7581   while (!Done) {
7582     switch (*Str++) {
7583     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7584     case 'I':
7585       RequiresICE = true;
7586       break;
7587     case 'S':
7588       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7589       assert(!Signed && "Can't use 'S' modifier multiple times!");
7590       Signed = true;
7591       break;
7592     case 'U':
7593       assert(!Signed && "Can't use both 'S' and 'U' modifiers!");
7594       assert(!Unsigned && "Can't use 'U' modifier multiple times!");
7595       Unsigned = true;
7596       break;
7597     case 'L':
7598       assert(HowLong <= 2 && "Can't have LLLL modifier");
7599       ++HowLong;
7600       break;
7601     case 'W':
7602       // This modifier represents int64 type.
7603       assert(HowLong == 0 && "Can't use both 'L' and 'W' modifiers!");
7604       switch (Context.getTargetInfo().getInt64Type()) {
7605       default:
7606         llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer type");
7607       case TargetInfo::SignedLong:
7608         HowLong = 1;
7609         break;
7610       case TargetInfo::SignedLongLong:
7611         HowLong = 2;
7612         break;
7613       }
7614     }
7615   }
7616 
7617   QualType Type;
7618 
7619   // Read the base type.
7620   switch (*Str++) {
7621   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown builtin type letter!");
7622   case 'v':
7623     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7624            "Bad modifiers used with 'v'!");
7625     Type = Context.VoidTy;
7626     break;
7627   case 'h':
7628     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7629            "Bad modifiers used with 'h'!");
7630     Type = Context.HalfTy;
7631     break;
7632   case 'f':
7633     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7634            "Bad modifiers used with 'f'!");
7635     Type = Context.FloatTy;
7636     break;
7637   case 'd':
7638     assert(HowLong < 2 && !Signed && !Unsigned &&
7639            "Bad modifiers used with 'd'!");
7640     if (HowLong)
7641       Type = Context.LongDoubleTy;
7642     else
7643       Type = Context.DoubleTy;
7644     break;
7645   case 's':
7646     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 's'!");
7647     if (Unsigned)
7648       Type = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
7649     else
7650       Type = Context.ShortTy;
7651     break;
7652   case 'i':
7653     if (HowLong == 3)
7654       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedInt128Ty : Context.Int128Ty;
7655     else if (HowLong == 2)
7656       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
7657     else if (HowLong == 1)
7658       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
7659     else
7660       Type = Unsigned ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
7661     break;
7662   case 'c':
7663     assert(HowLong == 0 && "Bad modifiers used with 'c'!");
7664     if (Signed)
7665       Type = Context.SignedCharTy;
7666     else if (Unsigned)
7667       Type = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
7668     else
7669       Type = Context.CharTy;
7670     break;
7671   case 'b': // boolean
7672     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'b'!");
7673     Type = Context.BoolTy;
7674     break;
7675   case 'z':  // size_t.
7676     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'z'!");
7677     Type = Context.getSizeType();
7678     break;
7679   case 'F':
7680     Type = Context.getCFConstantStringType();
7681     break;
7682   case 'G':
7683     Type = Context.getObjCIdType();
7684     break;
7685   case 'H':
7686     Type = Context.getObjCSelType();
7687     break;
7688   case 'M':
7689     Type = Context.getObjCSuperType();
7690     break;
7691   case 'a':
7692     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7693     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7694     break;
7695   case 'A':
7696     // This is a "reference" to a va_list; however, what exactly
7697     // this means depends on how va_list is defined. There are two
7698     // different kinds of va_list: ones passed by value, and ones
7699     // passed by reference.  An example of a by-value va_list is
7700     // x86, where va_list is a char*. An example of by-ref va_list
7701     // is x86-64, where va_list is a __va_list_tag[1]. For x86,
7702     // we want this argument to be a char*&; for x86-64, we want
7703     // it to be a __va_list_tag*.
7704     Type = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
7705     assert(!Type.isNull() && "builtin va list type not initialized!");
7706     if (Type->isArrayType())
7707       Type = Context.getArrayDecayedType(Type);
7708     else
7709       Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7710     break;
7711   case 'V': {
7712     char *End;
7713     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7714     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7715     Str = End;
7716 
7717     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error,
7718                                              RequiresICE, false);
7719     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require vector ICE");
7720 
7721     // TODO: No way to make AltiVec vectors in builtins yet.
7722     Type = Context.getVectorType(ElementType, NumElements,
7723                                  VectorType::GenericVector);
7724     break;
7725   }
7726   case 'E': {
7727     char *End;
7728 
7729     unsigned NumElements = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7730     assert(End != Str && "Missing vector size");
7731 
7732     Str = End;
7733 
7734     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7735                                              false);
7736     Type = Context.getExtVectorType(ElementType, NumElements);
7737     break;
7738   }
7739   case 'X': {
7740     QualType ElementType = DecodeTypeFromStr(Str, Context, Error, RequiresICE,
7741                                              false);
7742     assert(!RequiresICE && "Can't require complex ICE");
7743     Type = Context.getComplexType(ElementType);
7744     break;
7745   }
7746   case 'Y' : {
7747     Type = Context.getPointerDiffType();
7748     break;
7749   }
7750   case 'P':
7751     Type = Context.getFILEType();
7752     if (Type.isNull()) {
7753       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio;
7754       return QualType();
7755     }
7756     break;
7757   case 'J':
7758     if (Signed)
7759       Type = Context.getsigjmp_bufType();
7760     else
7761       Type = Context.getjmp_bufType();
7762 
7763     if (Type.isNull()) {
7764       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp;
7765       return QualType();
7766     }
7767     break;
7768   case 'K':
7769     assert(HowLong == 0 && !Signed && !Unsigned && "Bad modifiers for 'K'!");
7770     Type = Context.getucontext_tType();
7771 
7772     if (Type.isNull()) {
7773       Error = ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext;
7774       return QualType();
7775     }
7776     break;
7777   case 'p':
7778     Type = Context.getProcessIDType();
7779     break;
7780   }
7781 
7782   // If there are modifiers and if we're allowed to parse them, go for it.
7783   Done = !AllowTypeModifiers;
7784   while (!Done) {
7785     switch (char c = *Str++) {
7786     default: Done = true; --Str; break;
7787     case '*':
7788     case '&': {
7789       // Both pointers and references can have their pointee types
7790       // qualified with an address space.
7791       char *End;
7792       unsigned AddrSpace = strtoul(Str, &End, 10);
7793       if (End != Str && AddrSpace != 0) {
7794         Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, AddrSpace);
7795         Str = End;
7796       }
7797       if (c == '*')
7798         Type = Context.getPointerType(Type);
7799       else
7800         Type = Context.getLValueReferenceType(Type);
7801       break;
7802     }
7803     // FIXME: There's no way to have a built-in with an rvalue ref arg.
7804     case 'C':
7805       Type = Type.withConst();
7806       break;
7807     case 'D':
7808       Type = Context.getVolatileType(Type);
7809       break;
7810     case 'R':
7811       Type = Type.withRestrict();
7812       break;
7813     }
7814   }
7815 
7816   assert((!RequiresICE || Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) &&
7817          "Integer constant 'I' type must be an integer");
7818 
7819   return Type;
7820 }
7821 
7822 /// GetBuiltinType - Return the type for the specified builtin.
7823 QualType ASTContext::GetBuiltinType(unsigned Id,
7824                                     GetBuiltinTypeError &Error,
7825                                     unsigned *IntegerConstantArgs) const {
7826   const char *TypeStr = BuiltinInfo.GetTypeString(Id);
7827 
7828   SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes;
7829 
7830   bool RequiresICE = false;
7831   Error = GE_None;
7832   QualType ResType = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error,
7833                                        RequiresICE, true);
7834   if (Error != GE_None)
7835     return QualType();
7836 
7837   assert(!RequiresICE && "Result of intrinsic cannot be required to be an ICE");
7838 
7839   while (TypeStr[0] && TypeStr[0] != '.') {
7840     QualType Ty = DecodeTypeFromStr(TypeStr, *this, Error, RequiresICE, true);
7841     if (Error != GE_None)
7842       return QualType();
7843 
7844     // If this argument is required to be an IntegerConstantExpression and the
7845     // caller cares, fill in the bitmask we return.
7846     if (RequiresICE && IntegerConstantArgs)
7847       *IntegerConstantArgs |= 1 << ArgTypes.size();
7848 
7849     // Do array -> pointer decay.  The builtin should use the decayed type.
7850     if (Ty->isArrayType())
7851       Ty = getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
7852 
7853     ArgTypes.push_back(Ty);
7854   }
7855 
7856   if (Id == Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo)
7857     return QualType();
7858 
7859   assert((TypeStr[0] != '.' || TypeStr[1] == 0) &&
7860          "'.' should only occur at end of builtin type list!");
7861 
7862   FunctionType::ExtInfo EI(CC_C);
7863   if (BuiltinInfo.isNoReturn(Id)) EI = EI.withNoReturn(true);
7864 
7865   bool Variadic = (TypeStr[0] == '.');
7866 
7867   // We really shouldn't be making a no-proto type here, especially in C++.
7868   if (ArgTypes.empty() && Variadic)
7869     return getFunctionNoProtoType(ResType, EI);
7870 
7871   FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI;
7872   EPI.ExtInfo = EI;
7873   EPI.Variadic = Variadic;
7874 
7875   return getFunctionType(ResType, ArgTypes, EPI);
7876 }
7877 
7878 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForFunction(const ASTContext &Context,
7879                                              const FunctionDecl *FD) {
7880   if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
7881     return GVA_Internal;
7882 
7883   GVALinkage External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7884   switch (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7885   case TSK_Undeclared:
7886   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7887     External = GVA_StrongExternal;
7888     break;
7889 
7890   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7891     return GVA_StrongODR;
7892 
7893   // C++11 [temp.explicit]p10:
7894   //   [ Note: The intent is that an inline function that is the subject of
7895   //   an explicit instantiation declaration will still be implicitly
7896   //   instantiated when used so that the body can be considered for
7897   //   inlining, but that no out-of-line copy of the inline function would be
7898   //   generated in the translation unit. -- end note ]
7899   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7900     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7901 
7902   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7903     External = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7904     break;
7905   }
7906 
7907   if (!FD->isInlined())
7908     return External;
7909 
7910   if ((!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !Context.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
7911        !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) ||
7912       FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
7913     // FIXME: This doesn't match gcc's behavior for dllexport inline functions.
7914 
7915     // GNU or C99 inline semantics. Determine whether this symbol should be
7916     // externally visible.
7917     if (FD->isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible())
7918       return External;
7919 
7920     // C99 inline semantics, where the symbol is not externally visible.
7921     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7922   }
7923 
7924   // Functions specified with extern and inline in -fms-compatibility mode
7925   // forcibly get emitted.  While the body of the function cannot be later
7926   // replaced, the function definition cannot be discarded.
7927   if (FD->isMSExternInline())
7928     return GVA_StrongODR;
7929 
7930   return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7931 }
7932 
7933 static GVALinkage adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(GVALinkage L, const Decl *D) {
7934   // See http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/xa0d9ste.aspx
7935   // dllexport/dllimport on inline functions.
7936   if (D->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>()) {
7937     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR || L == GVA_StrongODR)
7938       return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7939   } else if (D->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
7940     if (L == GVA_DiscardableODR)
7941       return GVA_StrongODR;
7942   }
7943   return L;
7944 }
7945 
7946 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD) const {
7947   return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForFunction(*this, FD),
7948                                          FD);
7949 }
7950 
7951 static GVALinkage basicGVALinkageForVariable(const ASTContext &Context,
7952                                              const VarDecl *VD) {
7953   if (!VD->isExternallyVisible())
7954     return GVA_Internal;
7955 
7956   if (VD->isStaticLocal()) {
7957     GVALinkage StaticLocalLinkage = GVA_DiscardableODR;
7958     const DeclContext *LexicalContext = VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod();
7959     while (LexicalContext && !isa<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext))
7960       LexicalContext = LexicalContext->getLexicalParent();
7961 
7962     // Let the static local variable inherit its linkage from the nearest
7963     // enclosing function.
7964     if (LexicalContext)
7965       StaticLocalLinkage =
7966           Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(cast<FunctionDecl>(LexicalContext));
7967 
7968     // GVA_StrongODR function linkage is stronger than what we need,
7969     // downgrade to GVA_DiscardableODR.
7970     // This allows us to discard the variable if we never end up needing it.
7971     return StaticLocalLinkage == GVA_StrongODR ? GVA_DiscardableODR
7972                                                : StaticLocalLinkage;
7973   }
7974 
7975   // MSVC treats in-class initialized static data members as definitions.
7976   // By giving them non-strong linkage, out-of-line definitions won't
7977   // cause link errors.
7978   if (Context.isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
7979     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7980 
7981   switch (VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) {
7982   case TSK_Undeclared:
7983   case TSK_ExplicitSpecialization:
7984     return GVA_StrongExternal;
7985 
7986   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDefinition:
7987     return GVA_StrongODR;
7988 
7989   case TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration:
7990     return GVA_AvailableExternally;
7991 
7992   case TSK_ImplicitInstantiation:
7993     return GVA_DiscardableODR;
7994   }
7995 
7996   llvm_unreachable("Invalid Linkage!");
7997 }
7998 
7999 GVALinkage ASTContext::GetGVALinkageForVariable(const VarDecl *VD) {
8000   return adjustGVALinkageForDLLAttribute(basicGVALinkageForVariable(*this, VD),
8001                                          VD);
8002 }
8003 
8004 bool ASTContext::DeclMustBeEmitted(const Decl *D) {
8005   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8006     if (!VD->isFileVarDecl())
8007       return false;
8008     // Global named register variables (GNU extension) are never emitted.
8009     if (VD->getStorageClass() == SC_Register)
8010       return false;
8011   } else if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8012     // We never need to emit an uninstantiated function template.
8013     if (FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
8014       return false;
8015   } else if (isa<OMPThreadPrivateDecl>(D))
8016     return true;
8017   else
8018     return false;
8019 
8020   // If this is a member of a class template, we do not need to emit it.
8021   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
8022     return false;
8023 
8024   // Weak references don't produce any output by themselves.
8025   if (D->hasAttr<WeakRefAttr>())
8026     return false;
8027 
8028   // Aliases and used decls are required.
8029   if (D->hasAttr<AliasAttr>() || D->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
8030     return true;
8031 
8032   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8033     // Forward declarations aren't required.
8034     if (!FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
8035       return FD->doesDeclarationForceExternallyVisibleDefinition();
8036 
8037     // Constructors and destructors are required.
8038     if (FD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>() || FD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>())
8039       return true;
8040 
8041     // The key function for a class is required.  This rule only comes
8042     // into play when inline functions can be key functions, though.
8043     if (getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
8044       if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8045         const CXXRecordDecl *RD = MD->getParent();
8046         if (MD->isOutOfLine() && RD->isDynamicClass()) {
8047           const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunc = getCurrentKeyFunction(RD);
8048           if (KeyFunc && KeyFunc->getCanonicalDecl() == MD->getCanonicalDecl())
8049             return true;
8050         }
8051       }
8052     }
8053 
8054     GVALinkage Linkage = GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD);
8055 
8056     // static, static inline, always_inline, and extern inline functions can
8057     // always be deferred.  Normal inline functions can be deferred in C99/C++.
8058     // Implicit template instantiations can also be deferred in C++.
8059     if (Linkage == GVA_Internal || Linkage == GVA_AvailableExternally ||
8060         Linkage == GVA_DiscardableODR)
8061       return false;
8062     return true;
8063   }
8064 
8065   const VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(D);
8066   assert(VD->isFileVarDecl() && "Expected file scoped var");
8067 
8068   if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
8069       !isMSStaticDataMemberInlineDefinition(VD))
8070     return false;
8071 
8072   // Variables that can be needed in other TUs are required.
8073   GVALinkage L = GetGVALinkageForVariable(VD);
8074   if (L != GVA_Internal && L != GVA_AvailableExternally &&
8075       L != GVA_DiscardableODR)
8076     return true;
8077 
8078   // Variables that have destruction with side-effects are required.
8079   if (VD->getType().isDestructedType())
8080     return true;
8081 
8082   // Variables that have initialization with side-effects are required.
8083   if (VD->getInit() && VD->getInit()->HasSideEffects(*this))
8084     return true;
8085 
8086   return false;
8087 }
8088 
8089 CallingConv ASTContext::getDefaultCallingConvention(bool IsVariadic,
8090                                                     bool IsCXXMethod) const {
8091   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8092   if (IsCXXMethod)
8093     return ABI->getDefaultMethodCallConv(IsVariadic);
8094 
8095   if (LangOpts.MRTD && !IsVariadic) return CC_X86StdCall;
8096 
8097   return Target->getDefaultCallingConv(TargetInfo::CCMT_Unknown);
8098 }
8099 
8100 bool ASTContext::isNearlyEmpty(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) const {
8101   // Pass through to the C++ ABI object
8102   return ABI->isNearlyEmpty(RD);
8103 }
8104 
8105 VTableContextBase *ASTContext::getVTableContext() {
8106   if (!VTContext.get()) {
8107     if (Target->getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
8108       VTContext.reset(new MicrosoftVTableContext(*this));
8109     else
8110       VTContext.reset(new ItaniumVTableContext(*this));
8111   }
8112   return VTContext.get();
8113 }
8114 
8115 MangleContext *ASTContext::createMangleContext() {
8116   switch (Target->getCXXABI().getKind()) {
8117   case TargetCXXABI::GenericAArch64:
8118   case TargetCXXABI::GenericItanium:
8119   case TargetCXXABI::GenericARM:
8120   case TargetCXXABI::GenericMIPS:
8121   case TargetCXXABI::iOS:
8122   case TargetCXXABI::iOS64:
8123     return ItaniumMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8124   case TargetCXXABI::Microsoft:
8125     return MicrosoftMangleContext::create(*this, getDiagnostics());
8126   }
8127   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI");
8128 }
8129 
8130 CXXABI::~CXXABI() {}
8131 
8132 size_t ASTContext::getSideTableAllocatedMemory() const {
8133   return ASTRecordLayouts.getMemorySize() +
8134          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCLayouts) +
8135          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(KeyFunctions) +
8136          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ObjCImpls) +
8137          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(BlockVarCopyInits) +
8138          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(DeclAttrs) +
8139          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(TemplateOrInstantiation) +
8140          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingDecl) +
8141          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUsingShadowDecl) +
8142          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(InstantiatedFromUnnamedFieldDecl) +
8143          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(OverriddenMethods) +
8144          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(Types) +
8145          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(VariableArrayTypes) +
8146          llvm::capacity_in_bytes(ClassScopeSpecializationPattern);
8147 }
8148 
8149 /// getIntTypeForBitwidth -
8150 /// sets integer QualTy according to specified details:
8151 /// bitwidth, signed/unsigned.
8152 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8153 QualType ASTContext::getIntTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth,
8154                                            unsigned Signed) const {
8155   TargetInfo::IntType Ty = getTargetInfo().getIntTypeByWidth(DestWidth, Signed);
8156   CanQualType QualTy = getFromTargetType(Ty);
8157   if (!QualTy && DestWidth == 128)
8158     return Signed ? Int128Ty : UnsignedInt128Ty;
8159   return QualTy;
8160 }
8161 
8162 /// getRealTypeForBitwidth -
8163 /// sets floating point QualTy according to specified bitwidth.
8164 /// Returns empty type if there is no appropriate target types.
8165 QualType ASTContext::getRealTypeForBitwidth(unsigned DestWidth) const {
8166   TargetInfo::RealType Ty = getTargetInfo().getRealTypeByWidth(DestWidth);
8167   switch (Ty) {
8168   case TargetInfo::Float:
8169     return FloatTy;
8170   case TargetInfo::Double:
8171     return DoubleTy;
8172   case TargetInfo::LongDouble:
8173     return LongDoubleTy;
8174   case TargetInfo::NoFloat:
8175     return QualType();
8176   }
8177 
8178   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled TargetInfo::RealType value");
8179 }
8180 
8181 void ASTContext::setManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND, unsigned Number) {
8182   if (Number > 1)
8183     MangleNumbers[ND] = Number;
8184 }
8185 
8186 unsigned ASTContext::getManglingNumber(const NamedDecl *ND) const {
8187   llvm::DenseMap<const NamedDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8188     MangleNumbers.find(ND);
8189   return I != MangleNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8190 }
8191 
8192 void ASTContext::setStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD, unsigned Number) {
8193   if (Number > 1)
8194     StaticLocalNumbers[VD] = Number;
8195 }
8196 
8197 unsigned ASTContext::getStaticLocalNumber(const VarDecl *VD) const {
8198   llvm::DenseMap<const VarDecl *, unsigned>::const_iterator I =
8199       StaticLocalNumbers.find(VD);
8200   return I != StaticLocalNumbers.end() ? I->second : 1;
8201 }
8202 
8203 MangleNumberingContext &
8204 ASTContext::getManglingNumberContext(const DeclContext *DC) {
8205   assert(LangOpts.CPlusPlus);  // We don't need mangling numbers for plain C.
8206   MangleNumberingContext *&MCtx = MangleNumberingContexts[DC];
8207   if (!MCtx)
8208     MCtx = createMangleNumberingContext();
8209   return *MCtx;
8210 }
8211 
8212 MangleNumberingContext *ASTContext::createMangleNumberingContext() const {
8213   return ABI->createMangleNumberingContext();
8214 }
8215 
8216 const CXXConstructorDecl *
8217 ASTContext::getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
8218   return ABI->getCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8219       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()));
8220 }
8221 
8222 void ASTContext::addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(CXXRecordDecl *RD,
8223                                                       CXXConstructorDecl *CD) {
8224   return ABI->addCopyConstructorForExceptionObject(
8225       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getFirstDecl()),
8226       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()));
8227 }
8228 
8229 void ASTContext::addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8230                                                  unsigned ParmIdx, Expr *DAE) {
8231   ABI->addDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8232       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx, DAE);
8233 }
8234 
8235 Expr *ASTContext::getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(const CXXConstructorDecl *CD,
8236                                                   unsigned ParmIdx) {
8237   return ABI->getDefaultArgExprForConstructor(
8238       cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(CD->getFirstDecl()), ParmIdx);
8239 }
8240 
8241 void ASTContext::setParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D, unsigned int index) {
8242   ParamIndices[D] = index;
8243 }
8244 
8245 unsigned ASTContext::getParameterIndex(const ParmVarDecl *D) const {
8246   ParameterIndexTable::const_iterator I = ParamIndices.find(D);
8247   assert(I != ParamIndices.end() &&
8248          "ParmIndices lacks entry set by ParmVarDecl");
8249   return I->second;
8250 }
8251 
8252 APValue *
8253 ASTContext::getMaterializedTemporaryValue(const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *E,
8254                                           bool MayCreate) {
8255   assert(E && E->getStorageDuration() == SD_Static &&
8256          "don't need to cache the computed value for this temporary");
8257   if (MayCreate)
8258     return &MaterializedTemporaryValues[E];
8259 
8260   llvm::DenseMap<const MaterializeTemporaryExpr *, APValue>::iterator I =
8261       MaterializedTemporaryValues.find(E);
8262   return I == MaterializedTemporaryValues.end() ? nullptr : &I->second;
8263 }
8264 
8265 bool ASTContext::AtomicUsesUnsupportedLibcall(const AtomicExpr *E) const {
8266   const llvm::Triple &T = getTargetInfo().getTriple();
8267   if (!T.isOSDarwin())
8268     return false;
8269 
8270   if (!(T.isiOS() && T.isOSVersionLT(7)) &&
8271       !(T.isMacOSX() && T.isOSVersionLT(10, 9)))
8272     return false;
8273 
8274   QualType AtomicTy = E->getPtr()->getType()->getPointeeType();
8275   CharUnits sizeChars = getTypeSizeInChars(AtomicTy);
8276   uint64_t Size = sizeChars.getQuantity();
8277   CharUnits alignChars = getTypeAlignInChars(AtomicTy);
8278   unsigned Align = alignChars.getQuantity();
8279   unsigned MaxInlineWidthInBits = getTargetInfo().getMaxAtomicInlineWidth();
8280   return (Size != Align || toBits(sizeChars) > MaxInlineWidthInBits);
8281 }
8282 
8283 namespace {
8284 
8285   /// \brief A \c RecursiveASTVisitor that builds a map from nodes to their
8286   /// parents as defined by the \c RecursiveASTVisitor.
8287   ///
8288   /// Note that the relationship described here is purely in terms of AST
8289   /// traversal - there are other relationships (for example declaration context)
8290   /// in the AST that are better modeled by special matchers.
8291   ///
8292   /// FIXME: Currently only builds up the map using \c Stmt and \c Decl nodes.
8293   class ParentMapASTVisitor : public RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> {
8294 
8295   public:
8296     /// \brief Builds and returns the translation unit's parent map.
8297     ///
8298     ///  The caller takes ownership of the returned \c ParentMap.
8299     static ASTContext::ParentMap *buildMap(TranslationUnitDecl &TU) {
8300       ParentMapASTVisitor Visitor(new ASTContext::ParentMap);
8301       Visitor.TraverseDecl(&TU);
8302       return Visitor.Parents;
8303     }
8304 
8305   private:
8306     typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor> VisitorBase;
8307 
8308     ParentMapASTVisitor(ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents) : Parents(Parents) {
8309     }
8310 
8311     bool shouldVisitTemplateInstantiations() const {
8312       return true;
8313     }
8314     bool shouldVisitImplicitCode() const {
8315       return true;
8316     }
8317     // Disables data recursion. We intercept Traverse* methods in the RAV, which
8318     // are not triggered during data recursion.
8319     bool shouldUseDataRecursionFor(clang::Stmt *S) const {
8320       return false;
8321     }
8322 
8323     template <typename T>
8324     bool TraverseNode(T *Node, bool(VisitorBase:: *traverse) (T *)) {
8325       if (!Node)
8326         return true;
8327       if (ParentStack.size() > 0) {
8328         // FIXME: Currently we add the same parent multiple times, but only
8329         // when no memoization data is available for the type.
8330         // For example when we visit all subexpressions of template
8331         // instantiations; this is suboptimal, but benign: the only way to
8332         // visit those is with hasAncestor / hasParent, and those do not create
8333         // new matches.
8334         // The plan is to enable DynTypedNode to be storable in a map or hash
8335         // map. The main problem there is to implement hash functions /
8336         // comparison operators for all types that DynTypedNode supports that
8337         // do not have pointer identity.
8338         auto &NodeOrVector = (*Parents)[Node];
8339         if (NodeOrVector.isNull()) {
8340           NodeOrVector = new ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode(ParentStack.back());
8341         } else {
8342           if (NodeOrVector.template is<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8343             auto *Node =
8344                 NodeOrVector.template get<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>();
8345             auto *Vector = new ASTContext::ParentVector(1, *Node);
8346             NodeOrVector = Vector;
8347             delete Node;
8348           }
8349           assert(NodeOrVector.template is<ASTContext::ParentVector *>());
8350 
8351           auto *Vector =
8352               NodeOrVector.template get<ASTContext::ParentVector *>();
8353           // Skip duplicates for types that have memoization data.
8354           // We must check that the type has memoization data before calling
8355           // std::find() because DynTypedNode::operator== can't compare all
8356           // types.
8357           bool Found = ParentStack.back().getMemoizationData() &&
8358                        std::find(Vector->begin(), Vector->end(),
8359                                  ParentStack.back()) != Vector->end();
8360           if (!Found)
8361             Vector->push_back(ParentStack.back());
8362         }
8363       }
8364       ParentStack.push_back(ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode::create(*Node));
8365       bool Result = (this ->* traverse) (Node);
8366       ParentStack.pop_back();
8367       return Result;
8368     }
8369 
8370     bool TraverseDecl(Decl *DeclNode) {
8371       return TraverseNode(DeclNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseDecl);
8372     }
8373 
8374     bool TraverseStmt(Stmt *StmtNode) {
8375       return TraverseNode(StmtNode, &VisitorBase::TraverseStmt);
8376     }
8377 
8378     ASTContext::ParentMap *Parents;
8379     llvm::SmallVector<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode, 16> ParentStack;
8380 
8381     friend class RecursiveASTVisitor<ParentMapASTVisitor>;
8382   };
8383 
8384 } // end namespace
8385 
8386 ArrayRef<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode>
8387 ASTContext::getParents(const ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode &Node) {
8388   assert(Node.getMemoizationData() &&
8389          "Invariant broken: only nodes that support memoization may be "
8390          "used in the parent map.");
8391   if (!AllParents) {
8392     // We always need to run over the whole translation unit, as
8393     // hasAncestor can escape any subtree.
8394     AllParents.reset(
8395         ParentMapASTVisitor::buildMap(*getTranslationUnitDecl()));
8396   }
8397   ParentMap::const_iterator I = AllParents->find(Node.getMemoizationData());
8398   if (I == AllParents->end()) {
8399     return None;
8400   }
8401   if (auto *N = I->second.dyn_cast<ast_type_traits::DynTypedNode *>()) {
8402     return llvm::makeArrayRef(N, 1);
8403   }
8404   return *I->second.get<ParentVector *>();
8405 }
8406 
8407 bool
8408 ASTContext::ObjCMethodsAreEqual(const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodDecl,
8409                                 const ObjCMethodDecl *MethodImpl) {
8410   // No point trying to match an unavailable/deprecated mothod.
8411   if (MethodDecl->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>()
8412       || MethodDecl->hasAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
8413     return false;
8414   if (MethodDecl->getObjCDeclQualifier() !=
8415       MethodImpl->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8416     return false;
8417   if (!hasSameType(MethodDecl->getReturnType(), MethodImpl->getReturnType()))
8418     return false;
8419 
8420   if (MethodDecl->param_size() != MethodImpl->param_size())
8421     return false;
8422 
8423   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator IM = MethodImpl->param_begin(),
8424        IF = MethodDecl->param_begin(), EM = MethodImpl->param_end(),
8425        EF = MethodDecl->param_end();
8426        IM != EM && IF != EF; ++IM, ++IF) {
8427     const ParmVarDecl *DeclVar = (*IF);
8428     const ParmVarDecl *ImplVar = (*IM);
8429     if (ImplVar->getObjCDeclQualifier() != DeclVar->getObjCDeclQualifier())
8430       return false;
8431     if (!hasSameType(DeclVar->getType(), ImplVar->getType()))
8432       return false;
8433   }
8434   return (MethodDecl->isVariadic() == MethodImpl->isVariadic());
8435 
8436 }
8437 
8438 // Explicitly instantiate this in case a Redeclarable<T> is used from a TU that
8439 // doesn't include ASTContext.h
8440 template
8441 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8442     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::ValueType
8443 clang::LazyGenerationalUpdatePtr<
8444     const Decl *, Decl *, &ExternalASTSource::CompleteRedeclChain>::makeValue(
8445         const clang::ASTContext &Ctx, Decl *Value);
8446